1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.86"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
765 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
795 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1990 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2035 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2044 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2050 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2060 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062 given in addition to the short output.
2066 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2078 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2083 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089 and are often not needed.
2091 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2102 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121 containing the lines
2126 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2129 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2134 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2149 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2159 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169 syntax. For instance:
2172 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2174 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2179 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2185 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2188 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2199 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2203 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2206 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207 definition of all three of these variables into your
2208 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2211 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2216 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2223 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2230 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2232 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2241 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242 .cindex "building Eximon"
2243 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244 where the files that are involved are
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2253 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2263 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264 .cindex "installing Exim"
2265 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2278 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284 alternative files, no default is installed.
2286 .cindex "system aliases file"
2287 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293 and outputs a comment to the user.
2295 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2301 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2308 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2312 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2314 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318 but this usage is deprecated.
2320 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2327 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2335 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2340 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2342 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2348 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2350 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2354 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2357 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2361 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2363 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2365 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2369 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2374 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2381 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2387 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2397 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2399 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2405 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2412 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2414 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2418 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420 user agent. For example:
2422 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423 From: user@your.domain.example
2424 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 Subject: Testing Exim
2427 This is a test message.
2430 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2434 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2441 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2443 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2449 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450 .cindex "lock files"
2451 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2464 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2471 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2478 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2492 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2500 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2505 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507 favourite user agent.
2509 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2518 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2531 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2535 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2537 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2543 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2545 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2547 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2557 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2568 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571 were present before any other options.
2572 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2574 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2590 .cindex "queue runner"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2595 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2605 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2613 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2620 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2621 .cindex "envelope sender"
2622 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626 users to set envelope senders.
2628 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2634 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639 that are available to trusted users.
2641 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2647 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2652 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2657 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2663 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2671 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683 . creates a man page for the options.
2684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2687 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2694 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2700 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2701 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2705 .vitem &%--version%&
2706 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2707 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2714 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2717 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2719 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722 clean; it ignores this option.
2727 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728 .cindex "queue runner"
2729 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2733 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2738 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2743 When a listening daemon
2744 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2752 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2758 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764 because these are reread each time they are used.
2768 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2780 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784 test data. A line history is supported.
2786 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2792 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2794 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3059 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062 This option requires admin privileges.
3064 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3070 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3078 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3084 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3092 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097 arguments, for example:
3099 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3101 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106 users, the output is as in this example:
3108 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3110 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3111 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3113 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3115 backward compatibility.)
3116 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3117 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3119 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3120 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3121 name will not be output.
3123 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3124 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3125 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3126 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3127 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3128 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3129 written directly into the spool directory.
3131 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3133 exim -bP +local_domains
3135 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3136 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3138 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3141 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3142 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3143 that driver are output. For example:
3145 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3147 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3148 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3149 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3150 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3151 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3154 .cindex "environment"
3155 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3156 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3159 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3160 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3161 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3162 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3163 The output format is one item per line.
3167 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3168 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3169 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3170 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3171 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3172 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3173 to allow any user to see the queue.
3175 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3177 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3178 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3181 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3182 .cindex "size" "of message"
3183 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3184 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3185 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3186 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3187 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3188 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3189 before the sender address.
3191 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3192 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3193 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3195 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3196 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3197 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3198 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3199 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3205 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3206 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3207 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3213 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3214 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3215 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3216 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3221 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3222 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3223 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3224 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3228 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3232 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3237 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3238 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3239 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3240 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3245 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3246 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3247 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3248 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3249 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3251 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3252 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3254 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3255 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3256 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3257 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3258 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3259 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3260 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3261 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3262 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3264 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3265 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3270 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3271 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3272 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3273 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3274 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3275 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3276 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3280 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3281 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3282 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3283 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3284 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3285 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3286 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3287 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3288 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3290 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3291 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3292 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3294 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3295 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3296 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3297 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3299 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3300 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3301 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3303 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3304 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3305 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3306 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3307 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3309 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3310 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3314 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3315 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3316 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3317 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3318 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3319 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3320 messages to the MTA.
3323 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3324 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3325 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3326 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3327 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3328 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3329 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3333 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3334 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3335 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3336 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3337 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3338 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3339 the listening daemon.
3343 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3344 .cindex "address" "testing"
3345 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3346 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3347 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3348 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3349 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3351 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3352 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3354 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3355 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3358 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3359 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3360 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3361 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3362 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3365 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3366 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3367 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3368 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3370 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3371 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3372 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3373 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3376 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3377 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3379 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3380 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3381 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3382 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3383 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3384 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3389 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3390 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3391 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3392 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3393 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3394 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3396 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3397 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3398 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3399 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3400 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3401 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3402 dynamic testing facilities.
3406 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3407 .cindex "address" "verification"
3408 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3409 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3410 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3411 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3412 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3413 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3415 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3416 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3417 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3419 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3420 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3422 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3423 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3426 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3427 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3428 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3429 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3430 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3432 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3433 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3434 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3435 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3436 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3437 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3440 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3441 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3442 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3445 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3446 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3447 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3448 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3450 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3451 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3452 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3453 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3457 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3458 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3465 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3466 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3467 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3468 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3470 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3471 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3472 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3473 each port only when the first connection is received.
3475 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3476 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3478 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3480 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3481 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3482 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3483 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3484 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3485 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3486 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3487 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3488 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3490 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3491 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3492 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3493 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3494 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3495 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3496 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3497 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3498 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3500 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3501 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3502 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3503 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3504 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3505 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3506 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3508 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3509 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3510 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3511 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3512 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3513 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3514 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3516 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3517 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3518 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3521 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3522 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3523 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3524 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3525 specified by this option.
3528 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3530 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3531 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3532 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3533 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3534 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3535 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3537 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3538 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3539 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3540 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3541 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3542 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3543 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3545 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3546 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3547 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3553 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3554 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3557 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3559 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3561 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3565 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3567 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3568 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3569 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3570 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3571 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3572 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3573 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3576 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3577 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3578 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3579 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3580 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3581 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3582 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3585 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3586 &`auth `& authenticators
3587 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3588 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3589 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3590 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3591 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3592 &`filter `& filter handling
3593 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3594 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3595 &`ident `& ident lookup
3596 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3597 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3598 &`load `& system load checks
3599 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3600 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3601 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3602 &`memory `& memory handling
3603 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3604 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3605 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3606 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3607 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3608 &`retry `& retry handling
3609 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3610 &`route `& address routing
3611 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3613 &`transport `& transports
3614 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3615 &`verify `& address verification logic
3616 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3618 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3619 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3620 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3621 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3622 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3623 turn everything off.
3625 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3626 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3627 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3628 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3629 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3632 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3633 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3634 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3635 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3636 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3639 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3640 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3643 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3644 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3646 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3648 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3649 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3650 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3651 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3654 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3655 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3656 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3657 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3661 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3662 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3663 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3664 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3665 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3666 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3667 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3668 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3671 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3672 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3673 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3674 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3675 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3677 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3679 .cindex "sender" "name"
3680 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3681 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3682 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3683 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3684 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3685 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3687 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3689 .cindex "sender" "address"
3690 .cindex "address" "sender"
3691 .cindex "trusted users"
3692 .cindex "envelope sender"
3693 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3694 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3695 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3696 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3699 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3700 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3701 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3702 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3705 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3706 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3707 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3708 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3709 examples of shell commands:
3711 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3712 exim -f "" user@domain
3714 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3715 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3718 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3719 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3720 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3721 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3724 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3725 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3726 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3727 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3728 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3729 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3733 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3734 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3736 control = suppress_local_fixups
3738 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3739 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3742 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3745 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3747 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3748 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3749 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3754 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3755 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3756 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3757 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3758 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3759 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3761 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3763 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3764 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3765 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3766 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3767 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3768 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3770 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3772 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3774 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3775 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3776 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3777 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3778 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3779 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3780 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3783 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3784 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3785 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3786 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3787 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3788 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3790 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3791 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3792 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3793 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3795 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3797 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3798 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3799 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3800 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3801 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3802 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3803 can be used only by an admin user.
3805 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3806 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3808 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3809 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3810 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3811 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3812 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3813 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3814 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3815 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3819 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3820 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3821 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3825 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3826 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3827 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3833 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3835 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3837 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3839 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3840 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3841 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3842 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3846 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3847 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3848 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3853 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3854 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3855 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3857 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3859 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3860 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3861 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3862 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3863 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3864 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3865 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3866 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3867 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3868 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3869 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3870 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3871 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3873 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3875 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3876 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3877 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3878 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3879 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3880 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3881 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3882 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3884 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3886 .cindex "freezing messages"
3887 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3888 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3889 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3890 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3891 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3892 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3895 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3897 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3898 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3899 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3900 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3901 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3902 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3903 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3904 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3907 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3909 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3910 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3911 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3912 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3913 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3915 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3917 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3918 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3919 .cindex "removing recipients"
3920 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3921 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3922 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3923 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3924 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3925 can be used only by an admin user.
3927 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3929 .cindex "removing messages"
3930 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3931 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3932 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3933 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3934 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3935 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3936 placed on the queue.
3938 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3940 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3941 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3942 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3943 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3944 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3945 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3946 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3947 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3948 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3950 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3952 .cindex "thawing messages"
3953 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3954 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3955 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3956 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3957 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3958 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3961 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3963 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3964 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3965 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3966 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3968 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3970 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3971 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3972 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3973 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3974 only by an admin user.
3976 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3978 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3979 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3980 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3981 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3982 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3984 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3986 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3987 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3988 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3989 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3993 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3994 treats it that way too.
3998 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3999 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4000 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4001 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4002 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4003 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4004 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4007 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4008 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4009 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4010 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4011 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4012 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4013 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4018 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4019 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4020 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4021 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4023 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4025 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4028 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4030 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4031 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4032 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4035 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4037 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4038 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4039 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4040 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4041 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4042 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4046 .cindex "background delivery"
4047 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4048 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4049 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4050 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4051 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4052 processes to finish.
4054 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4055 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4056 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4057 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4059 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4060 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4061 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4062 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4066 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4067 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4068 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4069 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4070 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4071 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4073 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4074 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4077 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4078 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4080 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4081 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4082 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4083 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4088 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4093 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4094 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4095 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4096 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4097 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4098 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4099 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4100 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4101 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4102 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4107 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4108 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4109 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4110 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4111 configuration file is in effect.
4113 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4114 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4115 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4116 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4117 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4118 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4119 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4120 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4121 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4126 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4127 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4128 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4131 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4133 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4134 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4135 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4136 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4140 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4141 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4142 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4143 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4144 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4148 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4149 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4150 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4151 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4152 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4156 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4157 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4162 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4163 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4168 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4169 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4170 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4171 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4172 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4173 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4176 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4177 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4179 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4181 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4182 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4183 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4184 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4185 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4186 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4188 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4189 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4191 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4193 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4194 followed by a colon and the port number:
4196 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4198 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4199 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4200 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4201 whichever one is last.
4203 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4205 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4206 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4207 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4208 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4209 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4210 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4212 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4214 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4215 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4216 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4217 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4218 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4219 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4221 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4223 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4224 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4225 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4226 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4227 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4228 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4229 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4230 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4232 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4234 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4235 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4236 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4237 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4238 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4240 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4242 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4243 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4244 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4245 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4246 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4247 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4248 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4250 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4251 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4252 is sending the bounce.
4254 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4256 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4257 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4258 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4259 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4260 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4261 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4262 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4263 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4264 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4267 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4269 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4270 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4271 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4272 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4273 uses the name it is given.
4275 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4277 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4278 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4279 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4280 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4281 used, when there is no default.
4285 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4286 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4287 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4288 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4292 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4293 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4294 whatever that means.
4296 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4298 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4299 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4300 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4301 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4302 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4303 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4304 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4306 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4308 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4309 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4310 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4311 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4312 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4314 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4316 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4317 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4318 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4319 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4320 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4321 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4325 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4327 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4329 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4330 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4331 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4332 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4333 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4334 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4335 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4336 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4340 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4341 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4342 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4343 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4348 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4349 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4350 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4351 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4354 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4356 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4358 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4360 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4361 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4362 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4363 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4364 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4368 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4369 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4370 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4371 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4372 and &%-S%& options).
4374 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4375 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4376 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4377 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4378 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4379 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4382 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4383 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4384 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4385 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4386 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4389 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4390 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4391 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4392 this to be repeated periodically.
4394 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4395 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4396 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4397 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4399 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4400 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4401 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4403 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4404 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4405 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4406 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4410 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4411 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4412 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4413 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4414 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4415 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4418 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4419 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4420 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4421 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4422 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4423 delivered down a single SMTP
4424 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4425 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4426 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4427 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4428 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4431 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4433 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4434 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4435 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4436 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4437 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4439 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4441 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4442 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4443 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4444 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4445 their retry times are tried.
4447 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4449 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4450 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4453 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4455 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4456 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4457 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4460 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4461 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4462 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4463 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4464 starting message id. For example:
4466 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4468 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4469 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4470 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4472 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4474 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4475 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4476 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4477 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4478 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4479 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4481 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4482 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4483 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4484 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4485 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4486 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4487 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4488 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4489 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4491 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4493 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4494 process every 30 minutes.
4496 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4497 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4499 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4501 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4504 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4506 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4508 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4510 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4511 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4512 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4513 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4514 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4515 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4516 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4518 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4519 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4520 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4521 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4522 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4523 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4525 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4526 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4528 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4530 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4531 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4532 applied to each queue run.
4534 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4535 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4536 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4537 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4538 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4539 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4540 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4541 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4542 address will be skipped.
4544 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4545 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4546 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4549 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4550 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4551 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4552 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4553 an arbitrary command instead.
4557 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4559 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4561 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4562 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4563 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4564 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4565 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4566 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4568 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4570 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4571 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4572 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4576 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4577 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4578 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4579 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4580 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4581 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4582 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4583 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4584 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4586 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4587 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4588 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4589 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4590 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4591 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4592 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4593 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4594 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4595 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4596 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4598 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4599 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4600 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4601 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4602 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4603 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4605 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4606 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4607 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4608 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4609 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4610 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4611 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4612 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4613 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4617 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4618 compatibility with Sendmail.
4620 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4621 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4622 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4623 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4624 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4625 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4626 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4627 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4633 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4634 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4635 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4636 set. Exim ignores this option.
4640 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4641 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4642 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4643 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4644 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4645 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4650 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4651 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4652 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4655 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4657 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4658 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4660 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4662 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4663 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4664 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4673 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4674 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4675 . creates a man page for the options.
4676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4679 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4690 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4691 "The runtime configuration file"
4693 .cindex "run time configuration"
4694 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4695 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4696 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4697 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4698 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4699 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4700 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4701 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4704 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4705 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4706 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4707 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4708 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4709 actually alter the string.
4711 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4712 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4713 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4714 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4715 existing file in the list.
4718 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4719 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4720 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4721 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4722 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4723 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4724 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4725 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4726 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4727 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4729 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4730 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4731 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4732 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4733 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4735 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4736 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4737 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4738 compromise the Exim user account.
4740 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4741 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4742 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4743 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4744 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4745 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4750 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4751 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4752 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4753 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4754 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4755 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4756 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4757 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4758 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4759 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4760 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4762 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4763 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4764 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4765 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4766 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4767 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4768 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4769 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4770 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4773 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4774 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4775 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4776 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4777 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4779 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4780 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4781 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4782 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4783 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4784 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4786 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4787 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4788 necessarily be discarded.
4789 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4790 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4791 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4792 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4793 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4794 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4796 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4797 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4798 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4799 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4800 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4801 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4802 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4804 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4805 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4806 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4810 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4811 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4812 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4813 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4814 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4815 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4816 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4817 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4820 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4823 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4824 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4825 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4827 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4828 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4829 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4831 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4832 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4833 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4835 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4836 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4837 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4838 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4841 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4842 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4843 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4845 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4846 want to use this feature, you must set
4848 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4850 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4851 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4854 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4855 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4856 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4857 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4859 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4860 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4861 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4862 and does not introduce a comment.
4864 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4865 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4866 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4867 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4868 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4870 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4871 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4872 change settings as required.
4874 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4875 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4876 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4877 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4878 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4883 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4884 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4885 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4886 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4887 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4888 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4891 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4892 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4894 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4895 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4896 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4899 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4900 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4901 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4902 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4904 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4905 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4908 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4911 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4912 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4917 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4918 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4919 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4920 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4921 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4922 definition, and must be of the form
4924 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4926 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4927 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4928 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4929 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4930 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4932 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4933 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4934 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4936 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4937 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4938 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4939 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4940 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4941 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4942 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4945 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4946 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4948 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4949 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4950 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4951 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4952 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4953 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4956 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4957 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4958 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4963 MAC == updated value
4965 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4966 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4967 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4968 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4972 MAC == MAC and something added
4974 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4975 from a number of other files.
4977 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4978 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4979 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4980 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4981 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4986 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4987 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4988 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4989 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4991 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4992 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4994 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4996 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4998 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4999 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5000 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5003 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5004 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5005 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5006 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5007 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5008 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5009 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5011 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5012 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5013 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5017 message_size_limit = 50M
5019 message_size_limit = 100M
5022 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5023 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5024 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5025 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5026 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5028 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5029 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5030 in this line"& will always be true.
5032 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5033 to clarify complicated nestings.
5037 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5038 .cindex "common option syntax"
5039 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5040 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5041 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5042 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5043 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5044 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5045 space) and then the value. For example:
5047 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5049 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5050 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5051 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5052 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5053 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5054 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5055 word &"hide"&. For example:
5057 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5059 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5061 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5063 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5064 all instances of the same driver.
5066 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5067 that are found in option settings.
5070 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5071 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5072 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5073 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5074 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5075 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5076 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5077 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5078 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5079 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5080 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5081 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5086 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5091 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5096 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5097 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5098 .cindex "format" "integer"
5099 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5100 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5101 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5102 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5105 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5106 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5107 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5108 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5109 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5113 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5114 .cindex "integer format"
5115 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5116 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5117 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5118 Such options are always output in octal.
5121 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5122 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5123 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5124 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5125 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5129 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5130 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5131 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5132 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5133 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5143 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5144 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5145 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5149 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5150 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5151 .cindex "format" "string"
5152 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5153 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5154 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5155 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5156 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5157 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5158 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5159 therefore equivalent:
5161 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5162 trusted_users = uucp:\
5163 # This comment line is ignored
5166 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5167 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5168 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5169 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5170 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5173 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5174 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5175 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5177 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5178 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5182 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5183 character, that character replaces the pair.
5185 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5186 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5187 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5188 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5189 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5190 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5193 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5194 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5195 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5196 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5197 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5198 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5199 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5200 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5201 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5202 within a quoted configuration string.
5205 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5206 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5207 .cindex "format" "user name"
5208 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5209 .cindex "format" "group name"
5210 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5211 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5212 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5213 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5216 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5217 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5218 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5219 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5220 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5221 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5222 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5223 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5224 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5225 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5226 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5228 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5229 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5230 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5231 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5232 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5233 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5236 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5238 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5240 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5241 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5242 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5243 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5245 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5246 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5247 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5248 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5249 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5250 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5251 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5252 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5254 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5256 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5257 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5258 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5260 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5261 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5262 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5263 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5264 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5265 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5266 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5267 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5268 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5270 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5272 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5273 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5274 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5275 the value in quotes. For example:
5277 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5279 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5280 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5281 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5282 enclosing an empty list item.
5286 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5287 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5288 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5289 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5291 senders = user@domain :
5293 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5294 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5295 items, the second of which is empty:
5297 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5299 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5300 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5301 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5302 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5306 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5307 is at the end of the list.
5312 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5313 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5314 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5315 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5316 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5317 a sequence of lines like this:
5319 <&'instance name'&>:
5324 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5325 followed by three options settings:
5330 transport = local_delivery
5332 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5333 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5334 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5335 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5336 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5337 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5339 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5340 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5342 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5343 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5344 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5345 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5346 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5349 .cindex "generic options"
5350 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5351 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5352 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5353 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5354 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5355 .cindex "private options"
5356 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5357 they all have default values.
5359 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5360 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5361 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5363 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5364 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5365 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5366 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5367 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5368 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5369 configuration lines:
5374 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5375 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5376 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5377 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5383 command_timeout = 10s
5385 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5386 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5389 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5390 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5391 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5399 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5400 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5402 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5403 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5404 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5405 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5406 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5407 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5408 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5409 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5410 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5411 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5412 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5416 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5417 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5418 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5421 # primary_hostname =
5423 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5424 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5425 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5426 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5428 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5430 domainlist local_domains = @
5431 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5432 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5434 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5435 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5436 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5437 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5439 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5440 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5443 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5444 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5445 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5446 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5447 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5448 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5450 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5451 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5452 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5453 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5454 domain is permitted.
5456 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5457 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5458 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5459 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5460 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5461 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5463 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5464 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5465 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5467 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5469 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5470 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5472 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5473 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5474 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5475 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5476 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5477 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5478 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5479 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5480 contents of a message to be checked.
5482 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5484 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5485 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5487 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5488 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5489 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5490 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5492 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5494 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5495 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5496 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5498 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5499 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5500 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5501 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5502 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5503 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5504 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5506 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5508 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5509 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5511 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5512 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5513 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5514 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5515 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5516 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5517 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5518 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5519 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5520 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5521 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5522 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5523 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5524 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5525 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5526 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5528 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5531 # qualify_recipient =
5533 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5534 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5535 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5536 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5537 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5538 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5540 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5541 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5542 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5543 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5545 # allow_domain_literals
5547 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5548 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5549 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5550 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5551 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5552 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5554 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5558 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5559 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5560 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5561 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5562 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5563 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5564 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5565 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5567 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5568 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5573 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5574 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5575 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5576 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5577 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5578 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5581 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5582 1413 (hence their names):
5585 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5587 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5588 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5589 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5590 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5591 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5592 information, you can change this.
5594 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5595 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5600 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5601 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5602 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5603 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5605 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5606 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5608 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5609 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5611 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5614 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5615 +tls_certificate_verified
5618 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5620 # percent_hack_domains =
5622 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5623 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5624 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5626 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5627 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5628 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5629 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5630 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5631 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5632 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5633 always bounce messages.
5635 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5636 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5638 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5639 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5640 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5641 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5642 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5644 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5645 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5646 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5647 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5648 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5651 # split_spool_directory = true
5654 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5655 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5656 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5657 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5658 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5659 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5660 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5662 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5665 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5666 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5667 that are not 8-bit clean.
5669 # accept_8bitmime = false
5672 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5673 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5674 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5675 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5676 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5677 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5679 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5680 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5684 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5685 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5686 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5687 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5688 It starts with the line
5692 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5693 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5694 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5696 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5697 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5698 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5699 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5700 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5701 result of the ACL processing.
5705 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5710 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5711 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5712 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5713 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5714 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5715 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5717 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5718 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5719 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5722 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5723 domains = +local_domains
5724 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5726 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5727 domains = !+local_domains
5728 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5730 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5731 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5732 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5733 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5734 in Internet mail addresses.
5736 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5737 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5738 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5739 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5740 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5741 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5742 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5743 policy of being as safe as possible.
5745 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5746 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5747 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5748 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5749 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5750 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5752 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5753 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5754 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5755 have to modify this rule.
5757 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5758 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5759 common convention of local parts constructed as
5760 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5761 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5762 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5763 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5764 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5765 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5767 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5768 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5769 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5770 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5771 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5772 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5773 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5775 accept local_parts = postmaster
5776 domains = +local_domains
5778 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5779 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5780 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5781 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5782 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5784 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5785 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5786 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5788 require verify = sender
5790 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5791 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5792 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5793 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5794 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5795 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5796 discusses the details of address verification.
5798 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5799 control = submission
5801 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5802 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5803 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5804 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5805 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5806 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5807 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5808 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5809 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5811 accept authenticated = *
5812 control = submission
5814 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5815 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5816 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5817 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5818 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5819 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5821 require message = relay not permitted
5822 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5824 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5825 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5827 require verify = recipient
5829 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5830 fails, the address is rejected.
5832 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5833 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5835 # dnslists = black.list.example
5837 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5838 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5839 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5840 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5842 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5843 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5844 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5847 # require verify = csa
5849 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5850 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5855 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5856 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5860 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5861 of this ACL are commented out:
5864 # message = This message contains a virus \
5867 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5868 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5869 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5870 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5872 # warn spam = nobody
5873 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5874 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5875 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5876 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5878 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5879 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5880 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5881 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5882 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5883 whatever the spam score.
5887 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5890 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5891 .cindex "default" "routers"
5892 .cindex "routers" "default"
5893 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5898 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5899 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5900 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5901 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5902 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5905 # driver = ipliteral
5906 # domains = !+local_domains
5907 # transport = remote_smtp
5909 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5910 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5911 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5912 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5913 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5917 domains = ! +local_domains
5918 transport = remote_smtp
5919 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5922 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5923 domains. This is specified by the line
5925 domains = ! +local_domains
5927 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5928 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5929 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5930 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5931 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5932 passed on to the following routers.
5934 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5935 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5936 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5937 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5938 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5940 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5941 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5942 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5943 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5944 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5945 the address fails and is bounced.
5947 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5948 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5949 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5950 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5951 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5952 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5953 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5960 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5962 file_transport = address_file
5963 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5965 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5966 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5967 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5968 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5969 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5972 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5973 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5974 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5975 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5980 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5981 # local_part_suffix_optional
5982 file = $home/.forward
5987 file_transport = address_file
5988 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5989 reply_transport = address_reply
5991 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5992 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5993 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5994 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5995 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5998 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5999 # local_part_suffix_optional
6001 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6002 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6003 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6004 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6005 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6006 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6007 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6009 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6010 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6011 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6012 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6014 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6015 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6016 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6017 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6018 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6019 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6020 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6022 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6023 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6024 There are two reasons for doing this:
6027 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6028 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6031 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6032 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6033 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6034 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6038 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6039 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6040 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6041 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6043 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6044 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6045 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6047 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6049 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6055 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6056 # local_part_suffix_optional
6057 transport = local_delivery
6059 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6060 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6061 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6062 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6063 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6066 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6067 .cindex "default" "transports"
6068 .cindex "transports" "default"
6069 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6070 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6071 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6075 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6081 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6082 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6083 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6084 It is negotiated between client and server
6085 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6086 All other options are defaulted.
6090 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6097 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6098 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6099 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6100 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6101 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6102 show how this can be done.
6104 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6105 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6106 similarly-named options above.
6112 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6113 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6114 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6115 be returned to the sender.
6123 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6124 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6125 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6130 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6135 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6136 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6137 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6138 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6139 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6140 introduced by the line
6144 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6147 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6149 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6150 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6151 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6152 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6154 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6155 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6156 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6159 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6160 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6164 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6165 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6169 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6170 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6171 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6173 begin authenticators
6175 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6176 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6177 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6178 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6179 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6180 to support most MUA software.
6182 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6185 # driver = plaintext
6186 # server_set_id = $auth2
6187 # server_prompts = :
6188 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6189 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6191 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6194 # driver = plaintext
6195 # server_set_id = $auth1
6196 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6197 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6198 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6201 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6202 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6203 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6204 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6205 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6206 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6207 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6208 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6210 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6211 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6212 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6213 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6215 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6216 usercode and password are in different positions.
6217 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6219 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6223 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6224 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6226 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6228 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6230 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6231 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6232 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6233 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6234 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6235 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6237 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6238 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6239 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6240 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6241 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6244 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6245 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6246 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6247 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6249 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6251 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6252 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6253 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6254 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6255 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6256 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6259 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6260 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6261 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6262 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6263 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6264 match anywhere in the subject string.
6266 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6267 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6269 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6271 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6274 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6276 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6277 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6281 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6282 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6284 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6285 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6286 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6287 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6288 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6289 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6292 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6293 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6294 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6295 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6296 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6297 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6299 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6300 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6301 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6302 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6303 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6304 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6307 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6308 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6309 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6310 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6311 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6312 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6314 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6315 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6316 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6317 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6318 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6320 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6321 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6323 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6324 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6325 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6326 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6327 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6329 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6330 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6332 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6333 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6335 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6336 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6337 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6342 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6343 matches the list item.
6345 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6346 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6348 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6350 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6351 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6352 causes a second lookup to occur.
6354 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6355 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6356 lookup is permitted.
6359 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6360 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6361 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6362 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6365 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6366 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6367 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6369 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6370 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6371 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6372 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6375 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6376 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6377 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6382 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6383 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6384 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6389 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6390 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6391 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6392 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6395 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6396 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6397 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6398 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6399 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6400 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6401 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6402 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6403 be found in several places:
6405 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6406 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6407 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6409 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6410 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6411 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6412 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6414 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6415 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6416 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6417 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6418 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6419 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6420 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6422 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6423 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6424 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6425 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6426 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6427 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6428 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6430 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6431 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6433 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6434 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6435 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6436 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6437 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6438 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6439 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6441 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6442 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6443 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6445 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6446 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6447 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6448 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6449 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6450 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6451 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6452 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6453 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6454 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6456 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6457 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6458 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6459 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6460 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6461 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6462 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6463 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6464 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6466 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6467 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6468 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6469 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6470 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6471 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6472 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6474 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6475 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6476 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6477 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6479 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6480 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6481 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6482 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6483 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6485 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6486 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6487 lookup types support only literal keys.
6489 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6490 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6491 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6493 .cindex "linear search"
6494 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6495 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6496 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6497 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6498 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6499 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6500 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6501 in the file is used.
6503 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6504 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6505 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6506 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6507 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6512 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6513 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6514 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6515 wildcarding of any kind.
6517 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6518 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6519 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6520 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6521 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6522 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6523 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6524 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6525 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6528 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6529 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6530 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6531 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6532 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6533 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6534 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6535 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6538 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6539 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6540 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6541 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6542 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6543 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6544 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6545 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6546 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6548 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6549 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6550 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6551 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6553 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6554 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6557 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6559 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6560 *fish data for anythingfish
6563 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6564 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6566 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6568 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6569 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6570 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6572 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6574 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6575 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6576 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6578 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6581 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6582 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6583 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6584 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6585 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6587 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6588 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6589 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6590 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6591 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6594 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6595 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6596 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6599 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6601 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6604 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6605 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6606 be followed by optional colons.
6608 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6609 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6610 lookup types support only literal keys.
6614 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6615 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6616 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6617 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6618 many of them are given in later sections.
6621 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6623 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6624 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6625 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6627 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6628 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6629 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6631 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6632 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6633 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6634 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6635 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6636 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6637 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6639 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6640 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6641 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6642 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6644 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6645 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6646 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6647 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6649 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6650 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6651 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6652 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6654 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6655 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6656 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6657 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6658 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6659 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6660 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6661 password value. For example:
6663 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6666 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6667 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6668 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6669 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6673 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6674 .cindex lookup Redis
6675 &(redis)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6676 Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6680 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6681 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6682 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6683 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6686 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6687 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6689 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6690 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6691 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6692 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6693 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6694 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6695 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6696 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6697 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6699 require condition = \
6700 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6702 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6703 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6704 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6705 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6710 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6711 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6712 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6713 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6714 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6715 options such as a list of local domains.
6717 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6718 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6719 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6720 or may give up altogether.
6724 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6725 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6726 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6727 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6728 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6729 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6730 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6731 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6733 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6734 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6735 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6737 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6738 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6739 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6741 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6742 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6743 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6744 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6745 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6746 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6747 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6748 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6749 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6750 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6752 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6754 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6755 looks up these keys, in this order:
6761 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6762 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6763 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6764 Exim move on to try the next key.
6768 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6769 .cindex "partial matching"
6770 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6772 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6773 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6774 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6775 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6776 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6777 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6778 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6779 a key in a DBM file is
6781 *.dates.fict.example
6783 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6784 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6785 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6788 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6789 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6790 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6792 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6793 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6794 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6795 partial matching keys
6796 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6797 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6798 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6800 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6801 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6802 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6803 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6804 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6805 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6808 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6809 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6810 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6811 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6812 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6813 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6815 2250.dates.fict.example
6816 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6817 *.dates.fict.example
6820 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6823 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6824 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6825 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6826 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6827 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6828 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6830 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6832 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6833 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6834 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6835 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6837 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6839 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6840 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6842 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6843 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6844 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6847 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6849 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6850 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6852 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6853 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6854 for &"*"& on its own.
6856 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6860 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6861 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6862 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6863 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6864 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6865 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6866 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6868 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6869 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6870 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6871 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6872 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6877 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6878 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6879 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6880 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6881 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6882 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6883 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6885 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6886 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6887 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6888 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6889 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6890 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6892 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6893 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6899 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6900 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6901 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6902 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6903 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6904 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6908 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6909 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6911 [name="$local_part"]
6913 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6914 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6915 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6916 of the following form is provided:
6918 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6920 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6922 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6924 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6925 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6926 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6931 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6932 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6933 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6934 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6935 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6936 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6937 an expansion string could contain:
6939 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6941 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6942 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6943 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6944 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6946 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6947 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6948 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6950 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6951 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6952 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6953 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6954 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6956 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6958 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6959 white space is ignored.
6960 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6961 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6962 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6964 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6965 When the type is PTR,
6966 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6967 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6969 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6971 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6972 altered and nothing is added.
6974 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6975 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6976 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6977 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6978 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6979 The field separator can be modified as above.
6981 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6982 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6983 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6984 unless a field separator is specified.
6985 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6987 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6989 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6990 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6991 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6993 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6994 white space is ignored.
6996 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6997 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6998 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6999 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7002 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7005 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7006 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7007 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7008 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7009 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7010 each followed by a comma,
7011 that may appear before the record type.
7013 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7014 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7015 a defer-option modifier.
7016 The possible keywords are
7017 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7018 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7019 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7020 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7021 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7022 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7023 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7025 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7026 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7028 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7029 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7031 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7032 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7033 The possible keywords are
7034 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7035 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7037 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7038 is not labelled as authenticated data
7039 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7040 The default is &"never"&.
7042 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7044 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7045 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7046 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7047 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7049 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7051 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7052 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7053 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7056 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
7057 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7059 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7060 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7061 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7065 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7066 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7067 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7068 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7069 the pseudo-type MXH:
7071 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7073 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7076 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7077 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7078 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7079 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7080 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7081 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7082 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7083 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7085 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7086 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7088 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7089 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7090 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7092 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7093 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7094 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7095 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7096 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7099 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7100 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7101 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7102 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7103 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7104 result of a successful lookup such as:
7106 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7108 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7109 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7110 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7112 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7113 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7114 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7115 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7117 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7121 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7122 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7123 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7124 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7125 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7127 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7128 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7129 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7131 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7132 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7133 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7134 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7136 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7137 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7138 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7143 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7144 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7145 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7146 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7147 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7148 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7149 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7150 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7151 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7152 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7153 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7154 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7156 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7157 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7158 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7159 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7160 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7162 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7163 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7165 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7166 the way they handle the results of a query:
7169 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7172 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7173 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7175 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7176 from all of them are returned.
7180 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7181 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7182 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7183 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7186 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7187 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7188 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7189 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7191 data = ${lookup ldap \
7192 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7193 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7195 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7196 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7197 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7198 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7200 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7201 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7202 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7204 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7205 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7206 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7207 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7208 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7209 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7210 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7211 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7215 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7216 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7217 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7218 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7219 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7220 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7222 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7223 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7231 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7232 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7236 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7238 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7242 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7244 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7246 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7248 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7249 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7250 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7254 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7255 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7256 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7258 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7262 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7264 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7266 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7268 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7269 authentication below.
7272 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7273 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7274 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7275 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7276 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7279 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7281 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7282 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7283 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7284 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7285 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7286 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7287 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7288 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7289 failures, and timeouts.
7291 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7292 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7293 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7294 doubled. For example
7296 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7298 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7299 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7300 the local host) is used.
7302 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7303 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7304 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7305 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7308 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7309 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7310 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7311 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7313 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7315 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7316 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7318 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7320 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7321 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7322 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7323 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7324 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7325 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7326 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7329 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7330 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7331 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7334 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7337 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7341 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7342 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7346 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7347 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7348 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7349 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7350 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7351 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7352 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7353 them. The following names are recognized:
7355 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7356 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7357 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7358 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7359 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7360 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7361 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7362 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7364 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7365 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7366 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7367 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7369 .cindex LDAP timeout
7370 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7371 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7372 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7373 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7374 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7375 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7376 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7377 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7378 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7379 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7381 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7382 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7384 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7385 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7386 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7387 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7388 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7389 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7390 alternate list (colon-separated).
7392 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7393 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7396 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7397 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7400 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7401 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7402 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7403 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7405 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7406 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7407 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7409 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7410 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7411 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7412 quoting has two advantages:
7415 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7416 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7418 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7421 For example, a setting such as
7423 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7425 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7427 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7428 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7429 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7430 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7434 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7435 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7440 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7441 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7442 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7443 as a sequence of values, for example
7445 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7447 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7448 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7449 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7450 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7451 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7454 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7455 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7456 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7457 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7459 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7460 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7461 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7462 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7463 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7464 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7465 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7466 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7467 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7469 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7470 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7471 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7472 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7473 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7476 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7479 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7482 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7483 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7485 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7486 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7488 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7489 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7492 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7493 results of LDAP lookups.
7494 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7495 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7496 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7497 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7498 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7499 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7504 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7505 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7506 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7507 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7508 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7509 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7510 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7511 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7513 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7515 might return the string
7517 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7518 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7520 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7522 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7528 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7529 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7530 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7534 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7535 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7536 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7537 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7538 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7539 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7540 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7541 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7542 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7543 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7544 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7545 .cindex lookup Redis
7546 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7548 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7551 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7554 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7555 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7557 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7562 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7564 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7565 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7566 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7570 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7571 with a newline between the data for each row.
7574 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7575 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7576 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7577 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7578 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7579 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7580 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7581 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7582 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7583 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7584 .cindex lookup Redis
7585 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7586 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7587 or &%redis_servers%&
7588 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7590 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7591 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7592 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7594 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7595 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7596 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7597 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7599 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7601 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7602 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7603 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7605 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7606 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7608 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7609 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7610 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7611 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7612 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7613 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7616 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7617 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7618 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7620 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7621 host, database number, and password.
7623 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7624 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7625 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7627 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7629 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7634 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7635 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7636 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7637 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7639 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7640 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7643 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7644 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7645 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7646 done by starting the query with
7648 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7650 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7652 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7653 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7654 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7657 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7659 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7660 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7661 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7663 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7664 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7665 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7668 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7672 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7674 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7676 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7677 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7678 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7680 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7684 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7685 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7686 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7687 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7689 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7690 the default value is &"exim"&.
7692 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7694 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7695 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7697 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7698 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7700 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7703 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7704 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7706 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7707 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7708 is zero because no rows are affected.
7711 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7712 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7713 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7714 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7715 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7718 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7720 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7721 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7722 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7724 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7725 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7728 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7729 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7730 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7731 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7732 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7733 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7734 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7735 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7736 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7738 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7739 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7741 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7743 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7744 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7746 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7747 quote, which it doubles.
7749 .cindex timeout SQLite
7750 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7751 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7752 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7753 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7754 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7755 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7756 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7763 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7765 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7766 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7767 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7768 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7769 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7770 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7771 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7772 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7773 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7775 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7776 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7777 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7778 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7780 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7781 support all the complexity available in
7782 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7786 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7787 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7788 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7789 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7790 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7791 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7792 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7793 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7796 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7797 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7798 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7800 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7801 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7802 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7803 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7804 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7806 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7807 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7809 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7810 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7811 senders based on the receiving domain.
7816 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7817 .cindex "list" "negation"
7818 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7819 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7820 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7821 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7822 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7823 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7825 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7826 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7827 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7828 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7829 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7831 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7833 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7834 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7835 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7837 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7839 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7840 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7841 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7843 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7844 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7849 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7850 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7851 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7852 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7853 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7854 file names are not allowed,
7855 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7856 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7860 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7861 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7863 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7864 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7865 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7867 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7871 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7872 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7873 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7874 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7876 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7877 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7879 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7881 and the file contains the lines
7886 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7887 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7891 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7892 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7893 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7894 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7895 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7896 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7897 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7898 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7900 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7901 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7902 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7903 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7908 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7909 .cindex "named lists"
7910 .cindex "list" "named"
7911 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7912 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7913 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7914 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7915 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7916 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7917 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7919 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7921 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7922 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7923 configured with the line
7925 domains = +local_domains
7927 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7928 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7932 domains = ! +local_domains
7933 transport = remote_smtp
7936 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7937 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7938 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7939 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7941 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7942 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7944 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7946 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7947 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7948 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7950 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7951 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7952 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7954 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7955 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7957 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7958 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7959 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7961 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7963 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7964 referenced lists if you can.
7966 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7967 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7968 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7970 domains = +local_domains
7972 on several of your routers
7973 or in several ACL statements,
7974 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7975 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7976 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7977 the same each time they are referenced.
7979 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7980 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7981 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7982 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7986 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7987 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7988 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7989 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7990 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7993 ALIST = host1 : host2
7994 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7996 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7998 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8000 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8003 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8004 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8006 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8008 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8012 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8013 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8014 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8015 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8016 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8017 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8018 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8019 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8020 message. For example:
8022 domainlist special_domains = \
8023 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8025 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8026 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8027 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8028 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8029 same list each time.
8031 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8032 cache the result anyway. For example:
8034 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8036 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8037 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8041 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8042 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8043 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8044 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8045 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8048 .cindex "primary host name"
8049 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8050 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8051 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8052 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8053 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8054 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8055 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8056 differ only in their names.
8058 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8059 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8060 .cindex "domain literal"
8061 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8062 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8063 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8064 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8065 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8066 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8069 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8070 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8071 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8072 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8073 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8074 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8075 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8076 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8077 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8078 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8079 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8081 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8082 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8083 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8084 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8085 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8087 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8088 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8089 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8090 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8091 on a router). For example:
8093 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8095 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8096 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8098 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8099 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8100 contain negative items.
8102 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8103 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8104 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8106 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8107 an.other.domain : ...
8109 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8110 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8112 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8113 an.other.domain ? ...
8116 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8117 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8118 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8119 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8120 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8121 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8122 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8123 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8124 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8128 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8129 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8130 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8131 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8132 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8133 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8134 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8135 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8136 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8138 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8139 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8140 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8141 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8142 expression by expansion, of course).
8144 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8145 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8146 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8147 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8148 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8149 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8151 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8153 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8154 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8155 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8156 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8157 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8158 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8159 other statements in the same ACL.
8162 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8163 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8165 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8167 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8168 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8171 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8172 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8173 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8174 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8175 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8176 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8179 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8180 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8181 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8182 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8184 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8185 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8187 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8188 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8189 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8190 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8191 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8193 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8194 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8195 between the pattern and the domain.
8198 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8200 domainlist funny_domains = \
8203 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8204 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8205 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8206 nis;domains.byname : \
8207 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8209 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8210 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8211 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8212 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8213 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8218 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8219 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8220 .cindex "list" "host list"
8221 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8222 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8223 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8224 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8225 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8226 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8227 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8230 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8231 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8232 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8233 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8234 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8235 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8238 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8239 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8240 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8244 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8245 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8246 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8247 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8248 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8249 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8250 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8253 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8254 inspecting its IP address:
8257 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8258 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8259 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8260 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8261 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8262 with the IP address of the subject host.
8264 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8265 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8266 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8267 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8268 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8271 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8272 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8273 domain name, as just described.
8276 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8277 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8278 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8279 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8280 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8281 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8282 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8283 that can never match a client host.
8286 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8287 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8288 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8289 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8291 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8295 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8296 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8297 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8298 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8299 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8300 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8301 significant end of the address.
8303 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8304 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8305 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8306 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8310 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8311 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8314 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8316 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8317 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8319 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8320 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8323 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8325 could make use of a file containing
8330 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8331 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8332 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8334 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8337 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8343 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8344 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8345 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8346 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8347 address, the pattern takes this form:
8349 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8353 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8355 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8356 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8357 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8358 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8359 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8360 returned by the lookup is not used.
8362 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8363 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8364 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8365 patterns of this form:
8367 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8371 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8373 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8374 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8375 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8376 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8377 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8379 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8380 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8381 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8382 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8383 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8384 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8385 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8386 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8387 addresses are always used.
8389 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8390 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8391 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8394 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8395 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8396 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8397 case the IP address is used on its own.
8401 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8402 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8403 .cindex "unknown host name"
8404 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8405 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8406 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8407 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8408 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8411 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8412 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8413 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8414 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8415 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8416 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8417 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8419 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8420 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8422 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8423 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8424 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8425 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8426 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8427 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8428 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8429 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8430 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8432 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8433 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8435 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8436 .cindex "alias for host"
8437 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8438 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8441 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8442 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8443 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8444 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8445 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8448 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8449 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8450 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8451 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8452 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8453 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8454 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8459 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8460 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8461 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8462 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8463 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8465 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8467 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8468 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8469 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8476 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8477 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8478 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8479 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8480 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8481 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8483 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8484 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8486 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8487 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8488 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8489 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8490 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8491 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8492 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8493 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8494 not recognized in an indirected file).
8497 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8498 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8500 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8502 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8503 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8506 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8507 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8510 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8513 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8514 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8515 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8518 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8519 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8522 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8524 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8526 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8527 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8528 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8531 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8532 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8533 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8535 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8537 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8538 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8539 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8540 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8541 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8542 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8543 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8546 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8547 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8549 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8550 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8552 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8553 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8554 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8559 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8561 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8562 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8563 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8564 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8565 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8566 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8567 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8568 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8569 host lists such as whitelists.
8573 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8574 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8575 .cindex "unknown host name"
8576 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8577 If a pattern is of the form
8579 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8583 dbm;/host/accept/list
8585 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8586 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8589 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8590 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8591 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8592 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8593 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8594 lookup, both using the same file.
8598 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8599 If a pattern is of the form
8601 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8603 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8604 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8605 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8607 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8608 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8610 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8611 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8612 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8615 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8616 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8617 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8619 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8620 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8621 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8622 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8623 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8624 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8630 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8631 .cindex "list" "address list"
8632 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8633 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8634 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8635 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8636 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8637 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8638 using this option setting:
8642 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8643 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8644 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8645 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8647 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8650 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8652 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8653 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8654 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8655 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8656 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8657 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8658 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8660 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8661 *@+hostile_domains:\
8662 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8663 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8665 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8666 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8667 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8668 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8669 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8671 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8672 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8673 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8674 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8675 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8677 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8680 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8681 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8685 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8686 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8687 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8688 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8689 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8690 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8691 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8693 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8694 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8696 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8697 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8700 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8701 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8702 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8705 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8706 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8707 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8709 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8710 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8711 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8712 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8714 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8715 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8717 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8718 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8719 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8720 default. For example, with this lookup:
8722 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8724 the file could contains lines like this:
8726 user1@domain1.example
8729 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8732 nimrod@jaeger.example
8736 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8737 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8739 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8741 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8742 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8744 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8745 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8746 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8750 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8751 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8756 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8757 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8758 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8759 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8760 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8761 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8762 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8763 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8764 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8766 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8767 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8768 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8769 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8770 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8773 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8775 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8777 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8779 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8781 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8782 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8783 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8784 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8785 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8786 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8788 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8791 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8794 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8795 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8796 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8797 might have entries like
8799 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8800 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8803 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8804 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8805 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8806 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8808 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8809 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8810 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8813 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8814 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8815 can only return a single list of local parts.
8818 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8819 in these two examples:
8822 senders = *@+my_list
8824 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8825 example it is a named domain list.
8830 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8831 .cindex "case of local parts"
8832 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8833 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8834 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8835 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8836 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8837 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8838 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8839 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8842 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8843 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8844 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8845 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8846 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8847 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8848 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8851 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8852 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8853 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8854 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8855 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8856 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8857 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8858 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8862 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8863 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8864 .cindex "local part" "list"
8865 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8866 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8867 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8868 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8869 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8870 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8871 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8872 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8874 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8875 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8876 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8877 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8878 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8879 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8880 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8882 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8890 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8891 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8892 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8893 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8895 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8896 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8897 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8898 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8899 escape character, as described in the following section.
8901 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8902 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8903 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8904 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8905 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8910 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8911 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8912 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8913 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8914 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8915 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8916 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8917 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8919 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8920 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8921 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8922 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8924 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8926 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8927 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8932 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8933 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8934 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8935 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8936 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8937 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8938 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8941 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8942 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8943 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8946 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8947 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8948 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8950 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8951 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8952 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8953 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8954 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8955 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8956 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8959 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8960 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8961 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8964 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8965 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8966 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8967 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8969 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8971 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8972 Exim message identifier. For example:
8974 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8976 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8977 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8980 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8981 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8982 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8983 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8984 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8985 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8986 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8987 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8988 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8989 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8990 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8991 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8997 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8998 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8999 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9000 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9001 white space is significant.
9004 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9005 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9006 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9011 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9012 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9013 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9014 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9015 given, the expansion fails.
9017 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9018 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9019 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9020 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9024 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9025 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9026 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9027 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9028 string easier to understand.
9030 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9031 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9032 expansion item below.
9035 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9036 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9037 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9038 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9039 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9040 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9041 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9042 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9043 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9044 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9045 the result of the expansion.
9046 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9047 the expansion result is an empty string.
9048 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9051 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9052 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9053 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
9054 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9055 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9056 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9057 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9058 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9062 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9063 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9068 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9072 If the field is found,
9073 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9074 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9075 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9076 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9078 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9079 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9082 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9084 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9085 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9087 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9088 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9089 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9090 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9091 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9092 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9093 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9094 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9096 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9097 take an optional modifier of "int"
9098 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9099 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9100 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9102 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9103 newline-separated by default,
9104 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9105 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9106 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9108 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9109 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9110 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9111 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9112 if so the element tags are omitted.
9114 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9116 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9117 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9119 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9120 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9124 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9125 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9126 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9128 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9129 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9130 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9131 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9132 must have the following type:
9134 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9136 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9137 function should return one of the following values:
9139 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9140 into the expanded string that is being built.
9142 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9143 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9145 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9146 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9148 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9150 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9151 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9152 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9155 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9156 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9157 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9158 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9160 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9161 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9162 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9164 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9165 appear, for example:
9167 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9169 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9170 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9172 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9174 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9177 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9178 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9181 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9182 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9183 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9184 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9185 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9186 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9187 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9190 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9193 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9194 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9195 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9196 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9197 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9198 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9199 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9200 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9201 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9203 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9204 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9205 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9208 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9209 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9211 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9212 appear, for example:
9214 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9216 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9217 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9220 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9221 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9222 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9223 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9224 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9225 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9226 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9227 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9228 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9229 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9230 <&'string3'&> as before.
9232 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9233 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9234 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9235 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9236 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9237 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9238 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9239 provided. For example:
9241 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9245 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9247 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9248 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9251 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9252 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9253 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9255 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9256 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9257 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9258 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9259 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9260 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9261 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9263 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9265 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9266 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9269 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9270 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9271 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9272 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9273 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9274 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9276 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9277 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9278 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9279 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9281 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9283 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9284 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9285 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9286 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9287 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9289 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9291 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9292 letters appear. For example:
9294 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9295 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9296 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9299 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9300 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9301 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9302 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9303 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9304 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9305 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9306 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9307 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9308 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9309 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9310 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9311 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9312 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9316 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9317 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9318 lines) may be present.
9320 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9321 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9324 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9325 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9326 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9329 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9330 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9331 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9332 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9333 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9334 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9335 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9336 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9339 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9340 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9341 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9342 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9343 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9344 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9347 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9348 command of the following form:
9350 headers charset "UTF-8"
9352 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9353 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9354 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9355 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9356 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9359 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9360 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9361 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9362 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9364 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9365 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9366 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9367 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9368 router or transport are not accessible.
9370 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9371 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9372 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9373 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9374 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9375 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9377 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9378 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9379 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9380 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9381 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9382 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9383 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9386 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9387 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9388 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9389 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9390 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9391 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9392 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9393 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9396 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9397 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9399 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9400 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9401 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9402 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9403 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9404 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9405 present. For example:
9407 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9409 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9412 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9414 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9415 an Exim configuration:
9417 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9419 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9422 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9423 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9424 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9426 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9427 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9428 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9429 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9430 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9431 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9434 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9435 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9436 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9437 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9438 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9439 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9441 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9443 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9444 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9445 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9446 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9447 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9449 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9450 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9451 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9453 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9457 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9463 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9464 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9465 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9466 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9467 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9468 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9473 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9474 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9475 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9476 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9477 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9478 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9479 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9482 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9484 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9485 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9486 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9489 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9490 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9491 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9492 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9493 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9494 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9495 apart from an optional leading minus,
9496 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9498 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9499 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9501 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9502 If the number is negative, the fields are
9503 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9504 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9505 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9507 If the modulus of the
9508 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9509 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9513 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9517 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9519 yields &"result: 42"&.
9521 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9522 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9524 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9527 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9528 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9529 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9530 described in the next item.
9532 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9533 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9534 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9535 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9536 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9537 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9538 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9539 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9540 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9542 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9543 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9544 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9545 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9546 out by the system administrator.
9549 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9550 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9551 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9552 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9553 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9554 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9555 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9556 original lookup fails.
9558 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9559 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9560 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9561 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9562 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9563 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9564 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9565 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9567 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9568 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9569 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9570 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9572 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9573 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9574 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9575 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9577 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9579 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9581 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9582 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9584 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9589 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9590 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9592 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9593 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9594 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9595 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9596 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9597 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9599 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9601 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9602 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9603 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9605 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9606 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9607 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9608 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9609 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9610 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9611 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9613 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9615 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9616 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9617 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9618 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9621 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9623 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9627 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9628 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9629 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9630 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9631 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9632 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9633 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9634 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9636 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9637 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9638 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9639 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9640 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9643 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9644 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9645 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9647 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9648 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9651 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9652 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9653 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9654 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9655 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9656 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9657 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9658 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9660 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9661 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9662 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9663 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9664 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9665 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9666 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9667 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9668 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9669 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9671 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9672 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9673 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9674 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9676 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9677 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9678 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9679 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9680 is the expansion of the third argument.
9682 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9683 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9684 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9686 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9687 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9688 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9689 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9690 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9691 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9692 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9693 newlines are left in the string.
9694 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9695 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9696 the string expansion fails.
9698 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9699 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9703 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9704 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9705 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9706 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9707 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9708 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9709 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9712 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9713 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9715 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9716 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9717 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9718 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9719 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9722 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9724 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9725 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9726 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9727 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9728 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9729 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9730 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9732 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9734 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9735 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9736 turns them into spaces:
9738 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9740 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9741 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9742 addition, the following errors can occur:
9745 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9747 Failure to connect the socket;
9749 Failure to write the request string;
9751 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9754 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9755 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9756 errors occurs. For example:
9758 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9761 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9762 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9763 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9764 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9765 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9767 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9768 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9771 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9772 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9773 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9776 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9777 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9778 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9779 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9780 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9781 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9782 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9783 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9784 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9786 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9788 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9791 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9793 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9794 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9797 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9798 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9799 expansion item above.
9801 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9802 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9803 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9804 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9805 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9806 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9807 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9808 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9809 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9811 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9812 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9813 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9814 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9815 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9816 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9817 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9818 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9819 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9822 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9823 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9824 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9826 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9827 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9828 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9829 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9830 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9833 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9834 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9835 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9836 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9838 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9839 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9840 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9843 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9844 log_message = Output of id: $value
9846 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9847 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9849 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9853 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9854 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9856 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9857 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9861 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9862 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9865 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9866 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9867 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9868 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9870 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9871 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9874 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9875 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9876 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9877 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9878 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9879 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9880 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9881 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9883 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9885 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9886 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9887 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9889 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9891 yields &"defabc"&, and
9893 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9895 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9896 the regular expression from string expansion.
9900 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9901 .cindex sorting "a list"
9902 .cindex list sorting
9903 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9904 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9905 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9906 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9907 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9908 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9909 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9910 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9911 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9912 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9913 to give values for comparison.
9915 The item result is a sorted list,
9916 with the original list separator,
9917 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9921 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9923 sorts a list of numbers, and
9925 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9927 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9930 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9931 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9932 .cindex "substring extraction"
9933 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9934 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9935 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9936 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9937 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9939 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9941 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9942 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9945 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9946 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9947 length required. For example
9949 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9951 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9952 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9953 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9954 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9956 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9957 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9958 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9960 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9962 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9963 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9964 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9966 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9968 yields an empty string, but
9970 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9974 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9975 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9976 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9977 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9980 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9982 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9986 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9987 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9988 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9989 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9990 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9991 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9992 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9993 replacement list. For example
9995 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9997 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9998 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9999 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10005 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10006 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10007 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10008 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10009 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10010 following operations can be performed:
10013 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10014 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10015 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10016 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10017 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10018 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10021 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10022 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10023 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10024 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10025 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10026 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10027 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10028 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10029 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10031 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10032 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10033 character. For example:
10035 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10037 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10038 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10039 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10042 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10043 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10044 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10045 email address separator. For the example header line:
10047 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10049 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10050 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10051 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10052 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10053 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10054 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10057 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10058 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10060 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10061 Last:user@example.com
10062 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10066 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10067 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10068 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10069 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10070 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10071 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10072 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10073 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10074 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10076 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10077 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10078 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10079 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10080 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10081 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10085 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10086 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10087 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10088 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10089 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10090 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10092 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10093 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10096 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10097 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10098 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10099 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10100 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10104 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10105 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10106 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10107 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10108 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10111 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10112 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10113 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10114 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10115 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10116 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10117 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10120 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10121 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10122 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10123 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10124 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10125 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10126 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10127 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10128 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10129 C programming language):
10131 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10132 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10133 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10134 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10135 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10137 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10139 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10140 space is permitted before or after operators.
10142 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10143 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10144 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10145 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10146 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10148 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10150 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10151 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10154 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10155 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10156 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10157 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10158 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10159 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10160 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10161 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10162 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10163 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10164 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10167 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10169 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10172 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10175 {$recipients_count} \
10176 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10180 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10181 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10184 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10185 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10186 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10189 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10191 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10192 and then re-expands what it has found.
10195 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10197 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10198 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10199 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10200 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10201 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10202 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10203 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10204 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10205 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10207 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10208 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10209 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10210 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10211 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10212 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10213 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10216 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10217 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10218 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10219 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10220 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10221 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10223 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10225 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10226 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10230 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10231 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10232 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10233 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10234 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10235 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10239 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10240 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10241 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10242 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10243 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10244 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10245 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10249 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10250 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10251 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10252 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10253 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10254 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10255 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10257 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10258 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10259 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10260 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10261 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10262 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10263 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10264 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10265 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10269 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10270 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10271 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10272 .cindex "lower casing"
10273 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10274 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10275 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10280 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10281 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10282 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10283 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10284 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10285 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10287 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10289 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10290 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10291 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10294 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10295 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10296 .cindex "list" "item count"
10297 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10298 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10299 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10302 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10303 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10304 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10305 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10306 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10307 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10308 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10309 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10310 matching list is returned.
10313 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10314 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10315 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10316 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10317 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10321 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10322 .cindex "masked IP address"
10323 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10324 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10325 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10326 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10327 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10328 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10329 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10330 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10331 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10333 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10335 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10336 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10337 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10338 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10340 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10344 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10346 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10349 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10351 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10352 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10353 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10354 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10355 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10357 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10358 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10361 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10362 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10363 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10364 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10365 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10366 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10368 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10370 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10373 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10374 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10375 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10376 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10377 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10378 is an empty string or
10379 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10380 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10381 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10382 respectively For example,
10390 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10391 variable or a message header.
10393 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10394 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10395 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10396 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10397 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10398 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10399 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10402 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10403 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10404 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10405 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10406 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10408 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10414 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10415 yields an unchanged string.
10418 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10419 .cindex "random number"
10420 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10421 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10422 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10423 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10424 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10425 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10426 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10427 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10431 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10432 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10433 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10434 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10435 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10436 for DNS. For example,
10438 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10439 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10444 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10448 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10449 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10450 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10451 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10452 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10453 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10454 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10455 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10456 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10459 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10461 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10462 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10466 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10467 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10468 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10469 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10470 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10471 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10472 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10473 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10475 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10476 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10477 to use this operator as well.
10481 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10482 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10483 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10484 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10485 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10486 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10487 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10490 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10491 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10492 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10493 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10494 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10495 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10496 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10498 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10499 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10502 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10503 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10504 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10505 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10506 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10507 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10510 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10511 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10514 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10515 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10516 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10517 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10518 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10519 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10520 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10521 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10522 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10523 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10524 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10525 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10526 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10528 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10529 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10530 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10532 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10533 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10535 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10540 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10541 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10542 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10543 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10544 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10545 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10548 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10549 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10550 .cindex "substring extraction"
10551 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10552 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10553 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10554 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10556 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10558 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10559 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10561 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10562 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10563 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10564 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10567 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10568 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10569 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10570 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10571 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10572 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10575 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10576 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10577 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10578 .cindex "upper casing"
10579 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10580 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10581 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10583 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10584 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10585 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10586 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10587 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10588 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10589 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10592 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10593 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10594 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10595 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10596 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10597 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10599 .cindex internationalisation
10600 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10601 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10602 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10603 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10604 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10605 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10614 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10615 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10616 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10617 while expanding strings:
10620 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10621 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10622 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10623 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10626 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10627 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10628 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10629 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10635 &`>= `& greater or equal
10637 &`<= `& less or equal
10641 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10643 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10644 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10645 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10646 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10647 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10650 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10651 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10652 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10655 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10656 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10657 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10658 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10659 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10660 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10661 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10662 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10663 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10664 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10665 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10666 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10667 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10668 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10670 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10671 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10672 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10673 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10674 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10675 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10677 An empty string is treated as false.
10678 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10679 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10680 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10682 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10683 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10686 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10690 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10691 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10692 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10693 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10694 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10695 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10696 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10697 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10699 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10701 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10702 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10703 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10704 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10705 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10706 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10707 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10708 included in the binary.
10710 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10711 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10712 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10713 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10714 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10715 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10716 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10717 string in LDAP form is:
10719 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10721 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10722 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10724 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10726 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10731 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10732 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10733 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10734 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10735 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10736 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10740 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10741 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10742 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10743 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10744 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10745 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10748 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10749 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10750 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10751 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10752 whatever its length.
10755 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10756 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10757 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10758 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10760 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10761 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10762 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10763 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10764 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10765 support &[crypt16()]&.
10767 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10768 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10769 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10770 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10771 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10773 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10774 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10775 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10777 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10778 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10779 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10780 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10781 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10783 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10784 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10785 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10786 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10787 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10788 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10790 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10792 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10793 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10795 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10796 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10797 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10798 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10799 exists in the message. For example,
10801 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10803 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10804 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10806 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10807 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10808 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10809 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10810 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10811 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10812 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10813 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10814 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10816 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10817 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10818 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10819 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10820 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10821 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10822 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10823 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10825 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10826 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10827 .cindex "first delivery"
10828 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10829 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10830 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10831 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10834 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10835 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10836 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10837 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10838 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10840 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10841 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10842 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10843 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10844 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10846 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10847 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10848 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10850 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10851 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10852 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10854 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10855 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10856 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10857 list separator is changed to a comma:
10859 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10861 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10862 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10864 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10867 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10868 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10869 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10870 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10871 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10872 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10873 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10874 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10875 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10878 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10879 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10880 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10881 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10882 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10883 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10884 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10885 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10886 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10889 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10890 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10891 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10892 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10893 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10894 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10897 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10898 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10900 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10901 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10902 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10903 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10906 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10907 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10908 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10909 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10910 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10911 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10912 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10913 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10914 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10915 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10916 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10918 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10919 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10920 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10921 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10922 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10924 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10925 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10926 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10927 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10929 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10931 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10933 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10934 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10935 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10936 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10937 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10938 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10939 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10940 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10941 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10942 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10943 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10944 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10945 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10949 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10950 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10951 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10952 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10953 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10954 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10955 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10956 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10957 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10960 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10961 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10962 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10963 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10964 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10965 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10966 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10967 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10968 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10972 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10973 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10974 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10975 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10976 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10977 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10978 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10979 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10980 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10981 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10982 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10985 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10987 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10988 backslashes is also required.
10990 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10991 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10992 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10993 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10994 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10995 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10997 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10998 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10999 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11000 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11001 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11002 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11003 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11004 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11006 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11007 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11008 See &*match_local_part*&.
11010 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11011 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11012 See &*match_local_part*&.
11014 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11015 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11016 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11017 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11018 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11019 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11021 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11023 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11026 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11028 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11030 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11031 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11032 in a single test such as
11033 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11034 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11035 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11036 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11038 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11040 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11042 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11044 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11045 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11046 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11047 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11048 masks. For example:
11050 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11052 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11053 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11054 address mask, for example:
11056 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11058 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11059 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11061 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11065 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11066 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11068 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11070 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11071 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11072 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11073 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11074 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11075 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11076 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11077 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11080 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11082 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11083 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
11084 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11085 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11087 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11089 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11090 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11091 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11092 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11095 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11096 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11098 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11099 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11100 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11101 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11103 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11104 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11105 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11106 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11107 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11108 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11109 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11110 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11111 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11112 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11113 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11117 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11118 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11120 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11121 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11122 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11123 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11124 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11125 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11126 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11128 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11129 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11130 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11131 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11132 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11134 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11136 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11138 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11140 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11141 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11142 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11143 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11144 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11145 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11146 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11147 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11150 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11151 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11153 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11154 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11155 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11156 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11157 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11158 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11160 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11161 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11162 building Exim. For example:
11164 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11166 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11167 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11168 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11169 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11171 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11172 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11173 configuration, you might have this:
11175 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11177 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11179 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11181 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11182 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11183 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11184 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11185 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11186 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11189 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11191 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11192 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11193 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11194 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11195 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11198 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11199 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11200 this library, you need to set
11202 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11204 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11205 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11207 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11209 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11210 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11211 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11213 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11214 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11215 the authentication is successful. For example:
11217 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11221 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11222 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11223 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11225 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11226 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11227 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11228 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11229 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11230 by a process that is not running as root.
11232 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11233 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11234 building Exim. For example:
11236 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11238 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11239 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11240 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11242 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11243 two are mandatory. For example:
11245 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11247 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11248 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11249 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11254 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11255 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11256 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11257 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11258 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11259 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11260 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11264 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11265 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11266 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11267 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11268 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11271 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11273 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11274 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11275 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11277 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11278 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11279 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11280 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11281 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11282 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11283 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11284 parsed but not evaluated.
11286 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11291 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11292 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11293 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11294 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11295 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11298 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11299 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11300 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11301 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11302 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11303 In the expansion condition case
11304 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11305 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11306 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11307 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11308 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11309 matching condition.
11311 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11312 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11313 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11314 any unused variables being made empty.
11316 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11317 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11318 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11319 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11320 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11321 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11322 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11323 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11324 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11325 during subsequent delivery.
11327 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11328 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11329 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11330 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11331 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11332 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11333 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11334 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11337 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11338 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11339 this variable has the number of arguments.
11341 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11342 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11343 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11344 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11345 be preserved by coding like this:
11347 warn !verify = sender
11348 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11350 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11351 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11354 .vitem &$address_data$&
11355 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11356 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11357 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11358 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11359 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11360 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11363 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11364 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11365 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11366 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11367 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11368 from the child's routing.
11370 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11371 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11372 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11375 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11376 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11377 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11379 .vitem &$address_file$&
11380 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11381 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11382 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11383 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11384 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11386 /home/r2d2/savemail
11388 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11389 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11390 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11391 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11392 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11393 to the relevant file.
11395 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11396 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11397 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11398 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11400 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11401 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11402 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11403 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11405 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11406 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11407 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11408 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11409 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11410 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11411 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11412 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11413 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11414 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11415 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11416 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11417 command line option.
11419 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11420 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11421 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11422 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11423 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11424 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11425 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11426 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11427 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11431 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11432 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11433 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11434 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11435 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11436 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11437 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11438 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11439 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11440 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11441 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11443 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11444 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11445 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11446 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11447 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11450 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11451 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11452 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11453 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11454 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11455 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11456 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11457 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11458 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11459 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11460 an undefined mechanism.
11462 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11463 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11464 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11465 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11466 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11467 the ACL malware condition.
11469 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11470 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11471 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11472 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11473 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11474 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11476 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11477 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11478 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11479 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11480 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11481 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11482 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11484 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11485 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11486 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11487 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11488 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11490 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11491 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11492 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11493 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11494 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11496 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11497 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11498 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11499 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11500 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11501 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11502 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11504 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11505 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11506 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11507 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11508 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11509 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11510 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11512 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11513 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11514 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11515 address that was connected to.
11517 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11518 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11519 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11520 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11521 compilations of the same version of the program.
11523 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11524 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11525 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11526 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11527 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11528 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11530 .vitem &$config_file$&
11531 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11532 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11534 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11535 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11536 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11537 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11538 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11540 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11541 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11542 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11543 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11544 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11546 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11547 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11548 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11549 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11550 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11551 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11553 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11554 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11555 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11556 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11557 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11558 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11559 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11560 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11561 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11562 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11563 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11564 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11565 &$dkim_key_length$&
11566 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11567 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11569 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11570 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11571 When a message has been received this variable contains
11572 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11573 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11575 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11576 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11577 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11579 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11580 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11581 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11582 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11583 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11584 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11585 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11586 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11587 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11590 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11591 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11592 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11593 case for &$domain$&.
11595 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11596 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11597 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11598 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11600 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11601 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11602 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11603 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11604 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11605 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11607 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11608 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11609 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11611 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11614 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11615 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11616 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11617 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11618 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11619 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11620 the &(smtp)& transport.
11623 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11624 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11625 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11626 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11629 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11630 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11631 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11632 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11633 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11634 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11637 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11638 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11639 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11640 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11644 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11645 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11646 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11647 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11648 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11649 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11650 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11653 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11654 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11655 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11658 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11659 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11660 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11662 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11663 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11664 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11666 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11667 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11668 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11670 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11671 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11672 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11673 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11674 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11675 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11677 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11678 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11679 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11680 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11681 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11683 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11684 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11685 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11686 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11687 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11689 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11690 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11691 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11692 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11693 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11697 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11698 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11699 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11700 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11701 by a setting on the transport itself.
11703 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11704 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11705 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11709 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11710 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11711 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11712 to local and remote transports.
11714 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11715 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11716 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11717 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11718 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11719 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11720 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11723 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11724 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11725 client is connected.
11728 .vitem &$host_address$&
11729 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11730 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11731 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11732 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11734 .vitem &$host_data$&
11735 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11736 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11737 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11738 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11740 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11741 message = $host_data
11743 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11744 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11745 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11746 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11747 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11748 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11749 variables is set to &"1"&.
11752 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11753 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11756 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11757 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11758 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11761 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11762 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11763 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11764 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11765 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11766 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11767 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11768 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11769 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11770 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11772 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11773 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11774 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11776 .vitem &$host_port$&
11777 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11778 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11779 for an outbound connection.
11781 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11782 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11783 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11784 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11785 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11786 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11789 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11790 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11791 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11792 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11793 a unique name for the file.
11795 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11796 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11797 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11799 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11800 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11801 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11805 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11806 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11807 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11811 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11812 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11813 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11816 .vitem &$load_average$&
11817 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11818 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11819 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11820 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11822 .vitem &$local_part$&
11823 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11824 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11825 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11826 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11827 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11829 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11830 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11831 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11832 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11835 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11836 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11837 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11838 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11839 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11840 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11842 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11843 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11844 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11847 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11848 local part of the recipient address.
11850 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11851 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11852 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11854 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11857 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11858 abc\:xyz@test.example
11860 the value of &$local_part$& is
11864 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11865 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11868 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11870 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11871 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11872 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11874 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11875 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11876 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11877 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11878 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11879 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11880 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11882 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11883 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11884 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11885 variable expands to nothing.
11887 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11888 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11889 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11890 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11891 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11893 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11894 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11895 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11896 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11897 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11899 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11900 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11901 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11902 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11904 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11905 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11906 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11908 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11909 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11910 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11911 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11912 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11913 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11914 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11915 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11917 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11918 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11919 This contains the expanded value of the
11920 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11923 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11924 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11925 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11926 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11927 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11928 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11930 .vitem &$log_space$&
11931 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11932 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11933 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11934 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11935 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11936 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11939 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11940 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11941 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11942 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11943 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11944 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11945 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11946 and &"yes"& if it was.
11947 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11948 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11949 as authenticated data.
11951 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11952 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11953 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11954 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11955 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11956 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11957 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11960 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11961 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11962 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11963 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11964 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11966 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11967 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11968 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11969 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11970 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11971 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11974 .vitem &$message_age$&
11975 .cindex "message" "age of"
11976 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11977 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11978 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11981 .vitem &$message_body$&
11982 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11983 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11984 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11985 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11986 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11987 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11988 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11989 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11990 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11992 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11993 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11994 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11995 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11996 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11998 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11999 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12000 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12001 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12002 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12003 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12006 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12007 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12008 .cindex "message body" "size"
12009 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12010 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12011 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12012 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12013 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12015 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12016 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12017 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12018 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12019 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12020 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12021 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12022 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12024 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12025 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12026 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12027 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12028 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12029 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12031 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12032 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12033 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12034 contents of header lines is done.
12036 .vitem &$message_id$&
12037 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12039 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12040 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12041 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12042 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12043 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12044 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12045 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12046 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12047 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12048 from the body is not counted.
12050 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12051 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12052 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12053 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12054 header and the body).
12056 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12058 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12060 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12062 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12063 message has not yet been received.
12065 .vitem &$message_size$&
12066 .cindex "size" "of message"
12067 .cindex "message" "size"
12068 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12069 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12070 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12071 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12072 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12073 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12074 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12075 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12076 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12078 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12079 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12080 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12081 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12083 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12084 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12085 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12086 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12088 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12089 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12090 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12092 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12093 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12094 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12095 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12096 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12097 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12098 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12099 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12100 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12101 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12103 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12104 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12105 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12107 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12108 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12109 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12110 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12111 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12112 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12113 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12114 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12115 the original address.
12117 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12118 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12119 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12120 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12121 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12123 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12124 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12125 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12127 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12128 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12129 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12130 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12131 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12132 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12133 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12134 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12135 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12137 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12138 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12139 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12140 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12141 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
12142 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12143 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12144 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12147 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12148 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12149 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12150 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12152 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12153 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12154 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12155 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12158 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12160 This variable contains the current process id.
12162 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12163 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12164 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12165 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12166 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12167 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12168 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12169 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12170 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12171 variable"& error if encountered.
12173 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12174 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12175 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12176 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12177 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12178 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12179 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12183 .vitem &$proxy_host_address$& &&&
12184 &$proxy_host_port$& &&&
12185 &$proxy_target_address$& &&&
12186 &$proxy_target_port$& &&&
12188 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12190 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12194 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12195 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12196 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12197 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12200 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12201 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12202 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12203 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12205 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12206 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12207 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12208 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12210 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12211 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12212 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12213 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12215 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12216 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12217 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12219 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12220 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12221 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12222 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12224 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12225 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12226 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12227 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12228 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12230 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12231 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12232 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12233 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12234 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12235 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12237 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12238 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12239 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12240 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12241 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12243 .vitem &$received_count$&
12244 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12245 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12246 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12247 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12250 .vitem &$received_for$&
12251 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12252 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12253 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12254 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12255 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12257 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12258 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12259 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12260 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12261 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12262 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12263 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12266 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12267 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12268 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12269 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12270 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12272 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12274 .vitem &$received_port$&
12275 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12276 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12278 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12279 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12280 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12281 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12282 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12283 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12284 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12285 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12286 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12288 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12289 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12290 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12291 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12292 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12293 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12295 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12296 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12297 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12299 .vitem &$received_time$&
12300 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12301 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12302 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12304 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12305 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12306 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12307 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12308 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12310 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12311 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12313 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12314 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12315 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12316 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12318 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12319 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12320 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12321 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12324 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12325 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12328 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12331 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12332 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12336 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12339 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12342 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12343 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12345 .vitem &$recipients$&
12346 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12347 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12348 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12349 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12350 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12354 In a system filter file.
12356 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12357 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12358 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12359 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12361 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12365 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12366 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12367 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12368 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12369 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12370 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12373 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12374 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12375 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12376 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12378 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12379 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12380 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12381 these variables contain the
12382 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12385 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12386 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12387 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12388 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12389 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12390 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12391 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12393 .vitem &$return_path$&
12394 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12395 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12396 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12397 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12398 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12399 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12400 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12401 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12402 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12403 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12406 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12407 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12408 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12410 .vitem &$router_name$&
12411 .cindex "router" "name"
12412 .cindex "name" "of router"
12413 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12414 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12417 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12418 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12419 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12420 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12421 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12422 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12423 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12426 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12427 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12428 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12429 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12430 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12431 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12432 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12433 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12435 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12436 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12437 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12438 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12439 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12440 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12442 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12443 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12444 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12445 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12446 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12447 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12448 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12449 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12451 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12452 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12453 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12455 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12456 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12457 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12459 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12460 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12461 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12462 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12463 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12466 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12467 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12469 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12470 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12471 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12472 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12474 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12475 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12476 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12477 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12478 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12479 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12480 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12481 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12482 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12483 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12484 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12485 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12486 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12488 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12489 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12490 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12491 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12492 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12494 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12495 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12496 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12497 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12498 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12499 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12501 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12502 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12503 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12504 this variable contains that
12505 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12507 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12508 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12509 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12510 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12511 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12512 &$authenticated_id$&.
12514 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12515 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12516 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12517 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12518 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12519 resolver library states that both
12520 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12521 other times, this variable is false.
12523 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12524 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12525 library, by setting:
12530 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12531 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12533 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12534 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12537 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12538 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12539 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12540 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12541 other means, this variable is empty.
12543 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12544 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12545 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12546 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12547 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12548 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12549 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12551 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12552 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12553 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12554 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12556 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12557 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12558 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12561 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12562 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12563 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12564 following are true:
12567 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12569 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12570 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12571 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12573 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12574 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12575 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12577 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12578 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12579 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12581 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12582 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12583 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12584 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12586 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12588 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12589 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12593 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12594 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12595 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12596 number that was used on the remote host.
12598 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12599 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12600 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12601 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12602 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12605 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12606 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12607 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12608 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12610 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12611 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12612 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12613 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12614 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12615 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12616 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12617 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12618 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12619 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12620 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12623 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12624 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12625 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12626 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12627 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12629 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12630 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12631 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12632 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12633 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12635 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12636 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12637 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12638 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12639 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12640 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12641 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12643 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12644 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12645 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12646 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12647 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12649 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12650 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12651 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12652 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12653 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12654 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12656 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12657 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12658 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12659 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12660 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12665 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12666 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12667 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12668 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12670 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12671 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12672 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12673 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12674 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12675 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12676 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12678 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12679 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12680 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12681 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12682 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12683 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12684 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12685 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12686 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12687 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12688 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12690 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12691 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12692 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12693 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12694 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12695 message is junk mail.
12697 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12698 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12699 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12700 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12703 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12704 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12705 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12707 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12708 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12709 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12710 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12711 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12712 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12714 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12715 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12716 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12717 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12718 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12719 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12720 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12721 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12723 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12725 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12728 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12729 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12730 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12731 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12732 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12733 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12735 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12736 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12737 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12738 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12739 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12740 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12741 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12742 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12744 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12745 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12748 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12749 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12750 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12751 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12752 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12753 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12755 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12756 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12757 .cindex certificate veriables
12758 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12759 inbound connection when the message was received.
12760 It is only useful as the argument of a
12761 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12762 or a &%def%& condition.
12764 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12765 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12766 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12767 inbound connection when the message was received.
12768 It is only useful as the argument of a
12769 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12770 or a &%def%& condition.
12771 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12772 which is not the leaf.
12774 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12775 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12776 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12777 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12778 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12779 or a &%def%& condition.
12781 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12782 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12783 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12784 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12785 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12786 or a &%def%& condition.
12787 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12788 which is not the leaf.
12790 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12791 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12792 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12793 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12795 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12796 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12799 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12800 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12801 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12802 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12803 and &"0"& otherwise.
12805 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12806 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12807 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12808 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12809 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12810 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12811 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12812 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12813 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12815 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12816 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12817 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12819 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12820 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12822 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12823 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12824 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12825 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12827 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12828 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12829 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12830 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12832 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12833 1 No response to request
12834 2 Response not verified
12835 3 Verification failed
12836 4 Verification succeeded
12839 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12840 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12841 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12842 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12843 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12845 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12846 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12847 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12848 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
12849 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12850 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12851 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12852 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12853 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12854 which is not the leaf.
12856 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12857 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12860 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12861 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12862 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12863 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12864 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12865 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12866 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12867 which is not the leaf.
12869 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12870 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12871 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12872 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12873 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12874 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12875 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12876 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12877 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12878 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12879 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12881 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12882 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12885 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12886 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12887 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12889 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12892 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12893 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12894 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12895 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12897 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12898 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12899 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12901 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12902 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12903 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12905 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12906 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12907 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12908 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12909 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12910 values for those that are behind (west).
12913 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12914 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12915 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12917 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12918 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12919 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12920 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12923 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12924 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12925 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12928 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12929 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12930 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12931 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12933 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12934 .cindex "transport" "name"
12935 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12936 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12937 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12940 .vindex "&$value$&"
12941 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12942 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12943 &*reduce*& expansion.
12945 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12946 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12947 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12948 or for cutthrough delivery,
12949 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12952 .vitem &$version_number$&
12953 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12954 The version number of Exim.
12956 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12957 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12958 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12959 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12961 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12962 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12963 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12964 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12970 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12971 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12973 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12974 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12975 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12976 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12977 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12978 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12983 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12986 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12987 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12988 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12989 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12990 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12991 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12992 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12993 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12994 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12996 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12997 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12998 should usually be something like
13000 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13002 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13003 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13004 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13005 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13006 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13007 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13008 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13009 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13013 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13014 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13015 a startup when Exim is entered.
13017 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13018 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13021 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13022 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13025 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13026 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13027 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13028 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13032 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13033 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13035 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13036 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13037 with an error message of the form
13039 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13041 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13042 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13043 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13044 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13045 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13046 that was passed to &%die%&.
13049 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13050 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13051 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13054 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13056 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13057 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13058 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13060 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13061 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13062 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13063 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13065 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13066 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13067 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13068 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13069 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13070 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13071 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13074 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13075 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13076 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13077 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13078 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13079 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13080 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13081 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13082 avoided, but the output is lost.
13084 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13085 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13086 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13087 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13088 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13089 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13090 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13092 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13094 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13095 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13096 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13097 as the first subroutine argument.
13101 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13102 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13104 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13105 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13106 "Starting the daemon"
13107 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13108 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13109 .cindex "network interface"
13110 .cindex "interface" "network"
13111 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13112 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13113 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13114 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13115 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13116 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13117 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13118 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13119 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13120 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13121 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13124 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13125 and ports to listen on.
13127 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13128 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13129 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13130 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13131 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13132 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13133 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13134 as an error situation.
13136 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13137 for the outgoing connection.
13141 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13142 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13143 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13144 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13145 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13147 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13148 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13149 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13150 chapter describes how they operate.
13152 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13153 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13157 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13158 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13159 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13163 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13165 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13167 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13168 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13171 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13172 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13173 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13174 colons. For example:
13176 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13179 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13181 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13182 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13185 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13186 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13188 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13189 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13192 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13193 with a colon separator, for example:
13195 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13196 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13200 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13201 default setting contains just one port:
13203 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13205 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13206 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13207 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13208 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13209 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13213 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13214 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13215 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13216 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13217 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13218 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13220 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13222 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13224 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13226 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13230 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13231 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13232 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13233 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13234 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13235 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13238 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13239 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13240 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13241 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13242 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13243 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13247 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13250 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13252 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13253 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13254 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13258 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13259 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13260 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13261 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13262 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13263 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13264 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13265 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13266 list of port numbers or service names,
13267 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13268 common use of this option is expected to be
13270 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13272 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13273 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13274 this way when a daemon is started.
13276 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13277 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13278 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13279 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13280 connections via the daemon.)
13285 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13286 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13287 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13288 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13289 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13290 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13291 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13292 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13294 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13296 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13297 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13298 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13299 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13300 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13301 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13303 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13305 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13306 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13307 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13308 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13309 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13311 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13312 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13313 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13314 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13315 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13316 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13317 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13318 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13319 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13320 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13321 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13322 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13324 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13325 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13326 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13327 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13328 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13332 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13333 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13335 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13336 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13338 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13339 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13340 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13341 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13343 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13345 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13347 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13349 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13350 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13352 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13353 IPv4 loopback address only:
13355 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13357 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13359 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13361 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13365 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13366 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13367 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13368 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13371 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13372 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13373 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13374 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13376 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13377 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13378 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13379 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13380 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13381 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13382 used for listening. Consider this example:
13384 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13386 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13388 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13390 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13391 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13394 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13395 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13396 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13397 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13398 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13399 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13400 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13401 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13405 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13406 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13407 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13408 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13409 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13410 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13419 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13420 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13421 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13422 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13425 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13426 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13428 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13429 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13430 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13432 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13433 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13434 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13435 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13439 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13440 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13441 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13442 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13443 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13444 listed in more than one group.
13446 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13448 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13449 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13450 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13451 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13452 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13453 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13454 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13455 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13456 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13460 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13462 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13463 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13464 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13465 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13466 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13467 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13472 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13474 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13475 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13476 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13477 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13478 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13479 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13480 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13481 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13482 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13483 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13484 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13489 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13491 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13492 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13493 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13494 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13495 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13496 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13497 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13498 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13499 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13500 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13501 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13502 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13503 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13504 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13509 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13511 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13512 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13513 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13514 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13519 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13521 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13522 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13523 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13524 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13525 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13526 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13527 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13528 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13529 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13530 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13531 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13532 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13533 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13534 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13535 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13540 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13542 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13543 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13548 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13550 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13551 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13556 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13558 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13559 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13560 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13561 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13562 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13563 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13564 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13569 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13571 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13572 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13573 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13574 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13575 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13576 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13577 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13578 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13579 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13580 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13581 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13582 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13583 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13584 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13585 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13586 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13588 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13589 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13590 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13591 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13592 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13597 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13599 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13600 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13601 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13602 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13603 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13604 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13605 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13606 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13607 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13608 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13609 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13610 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13611 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13612 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13613 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13614 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13615 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13616 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13617 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13618 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13619 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13620 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13622 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13623 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13624 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13625 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13626 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13627 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13628 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13629 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13630 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13631 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13632 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13633 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13634 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13635 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13636 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13637 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13638 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13639 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13640 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13645 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13647 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13649 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13651 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13652 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13653 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13658 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13660 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13661 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13662 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13663 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13664 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13665 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13666 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13667 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13668 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13669 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13670 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13671 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13672 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13673 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13674 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13675 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13676 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13681 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13683 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13684 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13685 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13686 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13687 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13688 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13689 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13690 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13695 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13697 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13698 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13699 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13700 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13701 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13702 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13703 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13704 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13710 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13712 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13719 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13720 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13723 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13724 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13725 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13726 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13727 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13728 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13729 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13730 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13731 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13732 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13733 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13734 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13735 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13736 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13737 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13739 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13740 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13741 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13742 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13743 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13744 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13745 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13746 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13747 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13748 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13749 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13750 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13751 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13752 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13753 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13754 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13759 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13761 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13762 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13763 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13764 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13765 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13766 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13767 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13768 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13769 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13774 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13776 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13777 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13778 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13779 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13781 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13782 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13783 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13784 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13785 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13786 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13787 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13788 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13789 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13790 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13795 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13797 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13798 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13800 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13801 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13802 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13803 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13804 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13809 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13811 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13812 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13813 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13814 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13815 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13816 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13817 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13818 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13819 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13820 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13821 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13822 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13823 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13824 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13825 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13826 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13827 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13828 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13829 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13830 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13831 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13832 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13833 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13834 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13839 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13841 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13842 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13843 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13844 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
13845 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13846 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13847 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13848 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13849 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13850 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13851 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13852 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13853 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13854 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13855 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13860 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13861 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13864 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13866 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13867 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13868 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13869 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13870 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13871 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13872 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13874 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13875 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13876 It now defaults to true.
13877 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13879 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13882 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13884 log_selector = +8bitmime
13887 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13888 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13889 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13890 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13891 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13894 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13895 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13896 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13899 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13900 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13901 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13902 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13903 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13905 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13906 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13907 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13908 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13909 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13911 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13912 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13913 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13914 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13916 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13917 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13918 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13919 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13920 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13922 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13923 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13924 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13925 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13926 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13927 This option defines the ACL that,
13928 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13929 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13930 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13931 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13933 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13934 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13935 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13936 of a received message.
13937 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13939 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13940 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13941 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13942 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13944 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13945 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13946 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13947 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13949 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13950 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13951 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13952 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13953 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13956 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13957 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13958 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13959 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13961 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13962 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13963 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13964 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13965 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13967 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13968 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13969 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13970 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13971 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13973 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13974 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13975 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13976 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13977 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13979 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13980 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13981 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13984 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13985 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13986 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13987 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13989 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13990 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13991 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13992 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13994 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13995 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13996 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13997 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13999 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14000 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14001 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14002 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14005 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14006 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14007 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14008 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14009 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14012 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14013 .cindex "admin user"
14014 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14015 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14016 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14017 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14018 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14019 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14020 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14022 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14023 .cindex "domain literal"
14024 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14025 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14026 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14027 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14029 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14030 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14031 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14032 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14033 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14034 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14035 the local host's IP addresses.
14038 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14039 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14040 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14041 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14042 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14043 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14044 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14045 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14046 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14048 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14049 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14050 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14051 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14052 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14053 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14054 experiment if they wish.
14056 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14057 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14058 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14059 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14060 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14061 suitable setting is:
14063 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14064 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14066 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14068 dns_check_names_pattern =
14070 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14073 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14074 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14075 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14076 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14077 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14078 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14079 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14080 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14081 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14082 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14083 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14085 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14086 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14087 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14088 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14089 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14090 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14092 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14093 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14094 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14095 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14097 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14099 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14100 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14101 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14102 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14105 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14106 .cindex "thawing messages"
14107 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14108 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14109 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14110 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14111 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14112 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14114 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14115 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14116 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14119 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14120 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14121 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14123 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14125 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14126 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14129 .option bi_command main string unset
14131 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14132 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14133 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14134 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14137 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14138 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14139 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14140 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14141 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14142 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14145 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14146 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14147 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14148 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14150 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14151 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14152 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14153 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14154 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14155 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14156 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14157 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14158 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14159 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14161 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14162 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14163 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14164 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14165 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14166 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14167 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14168 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14169 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14170 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14172 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14173 during reception of a messsage.
14174 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14176 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14179 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14180 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14181 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14182 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14185 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14186 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14187 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14188 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14189 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14190 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14191 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14192 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14193 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14195 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14196 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14197 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14198 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14199 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14202 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14203 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14204 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14205 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14206 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14207 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14208 connection. A typical setting might be:
14210 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14212 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14214 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14216 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14219 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14220 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14221 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14222 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14223 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14224 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14227 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14228 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14229 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14230 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14233 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14234 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14235 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14236 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14239 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14240 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14241 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14242 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14245 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14246 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14247 callout verification. The default value is
14249 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14251 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14254 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14255 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14258 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14259 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14261 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14262 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14263 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14264 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14265 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14266 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14267 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14268 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14269 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14270 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14273 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14274 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14277 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14278 .cindex "checking disk space"
14279 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14280 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14281 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14282 message is accepted.
14284 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14285 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14286 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14287 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14288 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14289 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14290 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14291 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14294 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14295 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14297 check_spool_space = 10M
14298 check_spool_inodes = 100
14300 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14301 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14304 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14305 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14306 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14308 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14309 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14310 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14311 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14312 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14313 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14315 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14316 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14318 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14319 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14320 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14322 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14323 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14324 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14325 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14326 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14327 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14329 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14330 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14331 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14332 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14333 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14334 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14335 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14337 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14338 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14340 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14341 .cindex "warning of delay"
14342 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14343 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14344 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14345 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14346 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14347 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14348 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14351 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14353 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14354 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14355 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14356 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14360 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14361 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14363 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14365 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14366 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14367 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14369 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14370 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14371 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14372 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14373 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14374 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14375 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14376 not sent. The default is:
14378 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14379 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14380 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14381 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14384 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14385 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14386 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14387 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14389 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14390 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14391 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14392 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14393 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14394 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14395 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14396 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14398 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14399 .cindex "load average"
14400 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14401 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14402 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14403 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14404 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14407 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14408 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14409 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14410 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14411 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14412 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14413 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14414 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14416 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14417 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14418 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14419 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14420 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14421 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14422 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14423 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14425 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14426 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14427 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14428 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14431 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14432 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14433 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14434 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14435 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14436 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14437 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14440 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14441 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14442 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14443 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14444 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14445 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14448 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14449 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14450 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14451 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14452 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14453 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14454 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14455 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14456 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14457 by a setting such as this:
14459 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14461 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14462 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14463 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14464 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14465 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14466 options are applied after this global option.
14468 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14469 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14470 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14471 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14472 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14473 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14474 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14475 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14476 value of this option. The default pattern is
14478 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14479 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14481 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14482 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14483 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14484 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14485 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14488 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14489 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14490 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14492 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14493 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14494 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14495 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14498 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14499 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14500 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14501 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14502 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14503 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14505 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14508 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14509 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14510 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14511 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14512 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14513 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14514 domain matches this list.
14516 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14517 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14518 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14521 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14522 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14523 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14524 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14525 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14526 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14527 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14528 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14529 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14530 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14531 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14532 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14534 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14537 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14538 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14541 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14542 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14543 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14544 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14545 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14546 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14547 match with this expanded domain list.
14549 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14550 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14551 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14552 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14553 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14554 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14556 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14557 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14558 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14560 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14561 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14562 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14563 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14564 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14566 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14567 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14568 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14569 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14570 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14571 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14572 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14575 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14578 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14579 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14580 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14581 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14583 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14584 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14585 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14586 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14587 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14588 and accepted from, these hosts.
14589 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14590 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14591 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14592 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14595 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14596 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14597 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14598 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14599 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14600 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14602 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14604 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14605 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14607 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14608 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14609 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14610 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14611 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14612 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14613 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14614 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14615 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14618 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14619 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14620 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14621 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14622 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14623 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14624 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14625 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14626 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14628 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14629 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14630 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14631 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14632 are examined. For example:
14634 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14635 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14636 postmaster@mydomain.example
14638 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14639 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14640 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14641 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14642 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14643 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14644 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14647 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14648 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14649 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14651 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14653 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14654 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14655 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14656 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14657 overrides the default.
14659 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14660 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14661 and warning messages. For example:
14663 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14665 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14666 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14667 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14668 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14673 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14675 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14676 For details see &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14680 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14681 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14682 .cindex "Exim group"
14683 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14684 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14685 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14686 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14687 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14691 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14692 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14693 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14694 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14695 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14696 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14698 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14699 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14700 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14701 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14704 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14705 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14706 .cindex "Exim user"
14707 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14708 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14709 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14710 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14712 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14713 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14714 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14715 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14718 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14719 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14720 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14721 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14724 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14725 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14727 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14728 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14730 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14731 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14732 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14733 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14734 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14735 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14736 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14737 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14738 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14739 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14743 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14744 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14745 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14746 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14747 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14748 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14749 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14750 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14753 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14754 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14755 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14756 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14760 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14761 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14762 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14763 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14764 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14765 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14766 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14767 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14768 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14769 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14770 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14771 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14772 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14773 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14774 logging that you require.
14777 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14779 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14780 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14781 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14782 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14783 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14784 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14785 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14786 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14788 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14789 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14790 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14793 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14794 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14795 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14796 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14798 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14802 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14803 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14806 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14807 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14808 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14809 implementations of TLS.
14812 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14813 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14814 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14817 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14822 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14823 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14824 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14825 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14826 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14827 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14831 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14832 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14833 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14834 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14835 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14836 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14837 sections are rejected.
14840 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14841 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14842 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14843 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14844 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14845 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14846 zero means &"no limit"&.
14851 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14852 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14853 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14854 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14855 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14856 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14857 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14858 if you want to do semantic checking.
14859 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14863 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14864 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14865 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14866 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14867 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14868 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14869 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14871 helo_allow_chars = _
14873 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14876 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14877 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14878 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14879 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14880 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14881 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14882 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14886 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14887 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14888 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14889 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14890 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14891 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14892 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14893 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14894 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14895 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14896 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14897 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14899 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14900 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14901 EHLO command either:
14904 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14906 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14907 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14908 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14909 calling host address, or
14911 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14914 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14915 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14916 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14918 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14919 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14920 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14922 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14923 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14924 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14925 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14926 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14927 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14928 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14929 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14930 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14933 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14934 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14935 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14936 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14937 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14938 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14939 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14940 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14941 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14943 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14944 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14945 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14946 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14947 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14949 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14950 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14951 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14952 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14955 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14956 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14957 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14958 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14959 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14960 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14961 default configuration file contains
14965 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14966 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14968 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14969 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14970 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14972 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14973 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14974 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14975 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14976 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14977 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14980 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14981 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14982 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14983 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14984 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14987 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14988 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14989 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14990 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14994 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14995 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14996 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14997 as soon as the connection is made.
14998 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14999 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15000 connections immediately.
15002 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15003 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15004 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15005 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15006 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15009 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15010 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15011 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15012 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15013 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15014 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15015 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15016 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15017 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15019 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15021 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15026 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15027 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15028 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15029 connections. For details see &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15033 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15034 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15035 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15036 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15037 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15039 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15040 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15042 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15043 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15044 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15045 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15046 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15047 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15048 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15051 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15052 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15053 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15054 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15055 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15059 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15060 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15061 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15062 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15063 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15064 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15066 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15067 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15068 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15069 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15070 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15071 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15072 for frozen messages. For example,
15074 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15076 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15077 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15078 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15079 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15080 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15081 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15084 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15085 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15086 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15087 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15088 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15089 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15090 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15091 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15092 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15093 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15096 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15097 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15100 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15101 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15102 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15103 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15104 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15105 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15106 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15107 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15108 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15110 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15111 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15113 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15114 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15115 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15116 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15118 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15119 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15120 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15123 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15124 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15125 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15130 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15131 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15132 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15133 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15137 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15138 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15139 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15140 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15141 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15142 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15143 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15144 and constrained to be a directory.
15147 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15148 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15149 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15150 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15151 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15152 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15153 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15154 and constrained to be a file.
15157 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15158 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15159 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15160 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15161 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15162 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15165 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15166 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15167 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15168 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15169 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15170 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15171 identity to be proven.
15174 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15175 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15176 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15177 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15178 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15181 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15182 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15183 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15184 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15185 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15189 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15190 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15191 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15192 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15193 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15194 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15198 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15199 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15200 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15201 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15202 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15204 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15205 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15208 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15209 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15210 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15211 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15212 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15213 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15214 has been built with LDAP support.
15218 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15219 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15220 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15221 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15222 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15223 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15224 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15226 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15227 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15228 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15230 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15231 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15232 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15233 and the default qualify domain.
15235 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15236 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15237 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15238 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15240 .cindex "envelope sender"
15241 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15242 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15243 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15245 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15246 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15247 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15252 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15253 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15254 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15255 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15256 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15257 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15258 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15261 local_from_prefix = *-
15263 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15265 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15267 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15268 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15272 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15273 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15276 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15277 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15278 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15279 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15280 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15281 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15282 &%local_interfaces%& is
15284 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15286 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15288 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15291 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15292 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15293 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15294 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15295 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15296 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15297 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15298 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15302 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15303 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15304 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15305 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15306 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15307 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15308 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15309 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15314 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15315 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15316 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15317 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15318 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15319 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15320 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15321 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15322 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15323 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15324 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15325 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15326 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15327 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15328 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15332 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15333 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15334 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15335 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15336 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15337 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15338 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15339 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15340 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15341 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15342 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15343 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15344 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15345 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15346 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15349 .option log_selector main string unset
15350 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15351 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15352 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15353 minus characters. For example:
15355 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15357 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15358 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15361 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15362 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15363 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15364 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15365 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15366 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15367 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15368 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15369 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15370 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15371 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15372 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15373 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15376 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15377 .cindex "too many open files"
15378 .cindex "open files, too many"
15379 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15380 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15381 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15382 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15383 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15384 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15385 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15386 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15387 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15388 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15389 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15390 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15393 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15394 .cindex "length of login name"
15395 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15396 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15397 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15398 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15399 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15400 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15403 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15404 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15405 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15406 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15407 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15408 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15409 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15410 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15413 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15414 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15415 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15416 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15417 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15418 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15419 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15422 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15423 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15424 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15425 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15426 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15427 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15428 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15429 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15430 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15431 empty string, the option is ignored.
15434 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15435 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15436 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15437 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15438 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15439 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15440 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15441 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15442 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15443 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15444 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15445 colons will become hyphens.
15448 .option message_logs main boolean true
15449 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15450 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15451 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15452 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15453 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15454 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15455 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15456 which is not affected by this option.
15459 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15460 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15461 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15462 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15463 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15464 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15465 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15466 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15467 optionally followed by K or M.
15469 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15470 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15471 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15472 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15473 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15475 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15476 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15477 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15478 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15479 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15480 message that an individual transport can process.
15482 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15483 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15484 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15485 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15486 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15487 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15488 some problems may result.
15490 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15491 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15492 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15495 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15496 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15497 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15499 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15501 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15502 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15503 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15504 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15505 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15508 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15509 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15510 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15511 contains a full description of this facility.
15515 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15516 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15517 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15518 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15519 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15522 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15523 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15524 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15525 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15526 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15529 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15530 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15531 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15532 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15533 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15535 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15536 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15539 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15541 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15542 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15546 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use"
15547 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15548 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15549 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15550 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15552 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15553 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15554 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15555 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15556 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15557 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15558 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15560 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15561 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15562 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15563 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15564 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15566 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15568 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15569 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15570 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15571 some now infamous attacks.
15575 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15576 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15577 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15579 # Disable older protocol versions:
15580 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15583 Possible options may include:
15587 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15589 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15591 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15595 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15597 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15599 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15601 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15603 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15605 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15609 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15623 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15627 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15629 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15631 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15633 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15637 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15640 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15641 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15642 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15643 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15644 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15645 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15648 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15649 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15650 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15651 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15652 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15655 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15656 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15657 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15658 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15659 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15660 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15661 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15662 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15663 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15664 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15667 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15668 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15669 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15670 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15671 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15672 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15673 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15676 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15677 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15678 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15681 .option perl_startup main string unset
15682 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15683 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15686 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15687 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15688 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15689 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15690 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15691 PostgreSQL support.
15694 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15695 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15696 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15697 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15698 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15701 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15703 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15705 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15706 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15707 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15710 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15711 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15712 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15713 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15714 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15715 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15716 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15717 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15718 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15721 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15722 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15723 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15724 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15725 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15726 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15727 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15728 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15730 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15731 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15732 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15733 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15734 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15735 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15736 volume of mail. Use with care!
15739 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15740 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15741 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15742 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15743 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15744 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15745 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15746 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15747 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15748 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15750 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15751 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15752 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15753 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15754 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15755 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15758 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15759 .cindex "printing characters"
15760 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15761 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15762 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15763 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15764 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15765 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15768 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15769 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15770 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15771 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15772 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15776 .option process_log_path main string unset
15777 .cindex "process log path"
15778 .cindex "log" "process log"
15779 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15780 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15781 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15782 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15783 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15784 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15785 different spool directories.
15788 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15792 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15793 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15794 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15797 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15798 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15799 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15800 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15801 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15802 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15803 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15804 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15805 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15807 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15808 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15809 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15810 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15811 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15812 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15813 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15816 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15817 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15818 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15822 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15823 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15824 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15825 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15826 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15827 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15828 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15829 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15832 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15834 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15835 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15836 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15839 .option queue_only main boolean false
15840 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15841 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15842 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15843 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15844 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15845 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15847 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15848 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15849 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15850 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15853 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15854 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15855 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15856 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15857 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15858 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15859 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15860 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15861 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15863 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15865 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15866 &_/some/file_& exists.
15869 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15870 .cindex "load average"
15871 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15872 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15873 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15874 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15875 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15876 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15877 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15880 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15881 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15882 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15883 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15886 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15887 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15888 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15889 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15890 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15891 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15892 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15893 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15894 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15895 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15896 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15897 re-evaluated for each message.
15900 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15901 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15902 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15903 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15904 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15905 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15908 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15909 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15910 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15911 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15912 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15913 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15914 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15915 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15916 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15917 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15918 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15919 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15920 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15924 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15925 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15926 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15927 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15928 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15929 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15930 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15931 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15932 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15934 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15935 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15936 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15937 the daemon's command line.
15939 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15940 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15941 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15942 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15943 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15944 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15945 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15946 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15947 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15948 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15949 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15950 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15951 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15955 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15956 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15957 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15958 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15959 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15960 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15961 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15963 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15964 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15965 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15966 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15967 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15968 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15969 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15970 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15971 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15972 header lines. The default setting is:
15975 received_header_text = Received: \
15976 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15977 {${if def:sender_ident \
15978 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15979 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15980 by $primary_hostname \
15981 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15982 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15983 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15984 ${if def:sender_address \
15985 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15986 id $message_exim_id\
15987 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15990 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15991 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15992 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15993 header lines such as the following:
15995 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15996 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15997 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15998 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15999 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16000 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16001 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16003 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16004 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16005 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16006 message was accepted.
16009 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16010 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16011 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16012 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16013 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16014 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16015 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16016 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16019 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16020 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16021 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16022 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16023 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16024 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16025 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16026 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16027 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16028 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16029 option was not set.
16032 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16033 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16034 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16035 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16036 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16037 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16038 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16039 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16042 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16043 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16044 RCPT commands in a single message.
16047 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16048 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16049 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16050 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16051 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16052 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16053 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16056 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16057 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16058 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16059 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16060 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16061 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16062 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16063 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16064 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16065 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16066 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16067 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16068 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16069 tagged with its process id.
16071 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16072 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16073 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16074 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16077 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16078 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16079 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16080 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16081 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16082 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16083 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16084 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16085 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16086 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16087 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16089 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16090 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16091 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16092 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16095 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16096 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16097 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16098 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16099 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16101 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16103 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16104 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16107 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16108 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16109 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16110 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16111 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16115 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16116 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16117 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16118 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16119 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16120 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16121 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16125 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16126 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16127 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16128 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16129 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16130 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16131 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16132 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16133 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16134 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16137 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16138 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16141 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16143 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16144 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16145 an item in the list.
16146 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16149 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16150 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16151 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16152 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16153 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16156 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16157 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16158 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16159 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16160 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16161 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16162 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16163 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16164 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16165 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16167 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16168 .cindex "environment"
16169 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16170 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16171 default list is empty,
16174 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16175 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16176 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16177 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16178 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16179 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16180 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16184 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16185 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16186 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16187 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16188 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16189 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16190 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16191 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16192 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16193 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16194 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16198 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16199 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16200 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16202 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16203 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16204 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16205 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16206 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16207 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16209 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16210 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16211 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16212 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16215 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16216 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16217 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16218 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16219 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16220 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16221 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16222 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16224 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16225 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16226 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16227 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16228 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16229 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16230 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16231 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16234 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16235 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16236 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16237 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16241 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16242 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16243 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16244 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16245 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16246 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16247 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16248 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16249 . the option name to split.
16251 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16252 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16253 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16254 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16255 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16256 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16257 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16258 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16259 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16263 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16264 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16265 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16266 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16267 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16268 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16269 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16270 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16271 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16272 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16273 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16275 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16276 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16277 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16278 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16279 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16280 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16284 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16285 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16286 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16287 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16288 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16289 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16290 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16291 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16292 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16293 to all messages received in the same connection.
16295 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16296 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16297 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16298 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16301 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16303 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16304 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16305 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16306 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16307 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16308 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16309 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16310 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16311 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16312 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16313 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16314 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16315 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16318 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16319 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16320 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16321 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16322 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16323 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16324 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16325 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16326 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16327 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16328 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16331 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16332 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16333 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16334 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16337 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16338 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16339 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16340 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16341 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16342 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16343 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16344 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16345 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16347 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16348 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16349 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16350 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16352 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16353 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16354 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16355 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16356 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16359 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16360 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16363 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16364 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16365 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16366 &%helo_data%& value.
16368 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16369 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16370 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16371 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16372 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16373 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16374 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16376 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16377 $version_number $tod_full
16379 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16380 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16381 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16382 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16383 multiline response).
16386 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16387 .cindex "checking disk space"
16388 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16389 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16390 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16391 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16392 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16393 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16394 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16397 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16398 .cindex "connection backlog"
16399 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16400 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16401 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16402 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16403 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16404 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16405 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16406 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16407 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16408 attacks by SYN flooding.
16411 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16412 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16413 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16414 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16415 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16416 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16417 fewer, but they still exist.
16419 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16420 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16421 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16422 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16423 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16424 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16425 does detect many instances.
16427 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16428 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16429 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16430 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16434 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16435 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16436 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16437 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16438 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16439 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16440 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16441 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16444 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16445 $sender_host_address
16447 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16448 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16449 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16450 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16451 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16455 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16456 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16457 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16458 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16459 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16462 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16463 .cindex "load average"
16464 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16465 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16466 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16467 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16468 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16469 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16473 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16474 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16475 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16476 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16477 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16479 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16481 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16482 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16483 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16484 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16485 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16487 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16488 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16489 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16490 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16491 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16492 not count towards the limit.
16496 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16497 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16498 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16499 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16500 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16503 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16504 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16508 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16509 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16510 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16511 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16512 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16513 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16516 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16517 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16518 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16519 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16521 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16522 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16523 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16524 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16528 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16530 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16531 fractional parts are allowed here.
16533 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16535 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16536 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16539 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16540 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16542 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16543 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16545 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16546 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16547 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16548 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16551 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16552 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16555 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16556 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16559 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16560 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16561 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16562 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16563 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16564 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16565 the message is abandoned.
16566 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16568 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16569 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16571 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16572 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16574 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16575 expanded before use and may depend on
16576 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16580 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16581 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16582 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16583 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16584 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16587 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16588 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16589 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16592 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16593 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16594 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16595 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16596 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16597 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16598 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16599 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16600 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16601 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16603 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16604 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16609 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16610 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16611 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16612 the availability therof is advertised in
16613 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16614 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16618 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16619 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16620 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16621 The default value is
16625 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16629 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16630 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16631 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16632 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16633 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16634 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16635 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16636 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16637 arrival of the message.
16639 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16640 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16641 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16642 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16643 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16645 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16646 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16647 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16648 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16649 automatically deleted.
16651 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16652 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16653 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16654 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16655 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16656 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16657 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16658 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16659 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16662 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16663 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16664 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16665 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16666 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16667 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16668 &$primary_hostname$&.
16670 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16671 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16672 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16673 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16674 as failures in the configuration file.
16676 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16677 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16679 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16680 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16681 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16682 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16684 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16685 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16686 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16687 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16688 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16689 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16691 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16692 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16693 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16694 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16695 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16696 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16697 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16700 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16701 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16702 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16703 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16704 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16705 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16706 domain causes a syntax error.
16707 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16711 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16712 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16713 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16714 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16715 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16716 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16717 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16718 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16719 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16720 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16721 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16722 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16725 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16726 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16727 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16728 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16729 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16730 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16731 details of Exim's logging.
16735 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16736 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16737 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16738 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16739 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16743 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16744 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16745 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16746 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16747 details of Exim's logging.
16750 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16751 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16752 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16753 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16754 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16755 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16756 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16757 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16758 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16759 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16760 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16763 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16764 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16765 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16766 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16767 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16768 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16771 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16772 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16773 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16774 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16775 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16777 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16778 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16779 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16780 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16781 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16783 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16784 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16785 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16786 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16787 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16788 contains the pipe command.
16791 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16792 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16793 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16794 is used in a system filter.
16797 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16798 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16799 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16800 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16801 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16802 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16803 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16804 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16805 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16806 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16808 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16809 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16810 transport option overrides.
16813 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16814 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16815 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16816 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16817 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16818 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16819 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16820 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16821 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16822 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16823 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16824 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16828 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16829 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16830 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16831 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16832 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16833 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16834 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16835 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16836 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16837 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16839 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16840 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16841 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16844 .option timezone main string unset
16845 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16846 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16847 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16848 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16849 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16850 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16854 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16855 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16856 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16857 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16858 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16859 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16863 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16865 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16866 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16867 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16868 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16869 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16870 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16871 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16873 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
16874 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If no certificate is available then
16875 the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
16879 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16880 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16881 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16882 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16883 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16884 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16885 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16887 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16888 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16889 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16890 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16892 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16893 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16894 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16895 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16897 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16898 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16899 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16900 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16901 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16903 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16906 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16907 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16908 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16909 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16910 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16911 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16913 The value must be at least 1024.
16915 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16916 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16917 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16919 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16922 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16923 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16924 larger prime than requested.
16927 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16928 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16929 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16930 to be used by Exim.
16932 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16933 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16934 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16935 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16936 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16937 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16938 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16940 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16943 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16944 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16945 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16946 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16948 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16949 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16950 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16951 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16953 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16954 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16955 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16958 The available primes are:
16959 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16960 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16961 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16963 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16964 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16966 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16967 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16968 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16969 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16970 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16973 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16974 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16975 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16976 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16977 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16978 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16979 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16982 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16983 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16984 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16985 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16987 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16988 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16989 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16990 which tells the library to choose.
16992 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16995 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16996 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16997 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16999 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17000 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17001 Certificate Authority.
17004 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17008 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17011 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17012 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17013 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17014 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17018 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
17019 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17020 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
17021 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
17022 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17023 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17024 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17026 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17029 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17030 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17031 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17032 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17033 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17034 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17038 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17039 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17040 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17041 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17042 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17043 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17044 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17045 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17046 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17047 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17048 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17051 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17052 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17053 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17054 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17057 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17058 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17059 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17060 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17062 or the absolute path to
17063 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17064 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17066 The "system" value for the option will use a
17067 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17068 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17069 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17072 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17073 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17075 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17077 either by file or directory
17078 are added to those given by the system default location.
17080 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17081 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17082 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17083 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17084 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17085 use the explicit directory version.
17087 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17089 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17093 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17094 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17095 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17096 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17097 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17098 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17099 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17100 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17102 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17103 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17104 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17105 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17106 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17107 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17108 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17110 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17111 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17112 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17113 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17114 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17115 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17116 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17119 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17123 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17124 .cindex "trusted groups"
17125 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17126 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17127 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17128 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17129 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17130 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17131 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17134 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17135 .cindex "trusted users"
17136 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17137 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17138 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17139 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17140 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17141 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17142 Exim user are trusted.
17144 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17145 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17146 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17147 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17148 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17149 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17150 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17151 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17152 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17155 .option unknown_username main string unset
17156 See &%unknown_login%&.
17158 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17159 .cindex "trusted users"
17160 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17161 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17162 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17163 .cindex "envelope sender"
17164 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17165 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17166 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17167 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17168 is used) is ignored.
17170 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17171 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17173 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17175 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17176 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17177 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17178 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17179 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17180 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17181 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17182 followed by a hyphen
17183 by a setting like this:
17185 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17187 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17188 restriction, you can use
17190 untrusted_set_sender = *
17192 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17193 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17194 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17195 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17196 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17197 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17198 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17199 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17201 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17202 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17203 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17204 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17208 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17209 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17210 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17211 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17212 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17213 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17214 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17215 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17216 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17217 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17219 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17220 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17222 The pattern can be seen by running
17224 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17226 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17227 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17228 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17229 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17230 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17231 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17234 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17235 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17238 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17239 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17240 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17241 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17242 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17243 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17244 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17245 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17248 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17249 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17250 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17251 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17252 .ecindex IIDconfima
17253 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17258 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17259 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17261 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17262 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17263 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17264 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17265 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
17267 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17268 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17269 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17270 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17271 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17275 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17276 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17277 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17278 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17279 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17280 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17281 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17283 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17284 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17285 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17286 routers, and the eventual transport.
17288 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17289 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17290 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17291 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17292 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17294 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17295 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17296 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17297 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17298 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17300 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17301 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17302 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17304 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17306 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17308 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17310 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17311 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17313 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17314 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17315 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17316 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17317 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17318 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17319 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17323 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17325 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17326 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17327 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17328 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17329 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17334 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17335 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17336 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17337 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17338 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17339 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17340 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17341 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17342 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17343 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17346 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17348 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17351 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17353 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17354 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17355 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17356 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17359 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17360 .cindex "case of local parts"
17361 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17362 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17363 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17364 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17365 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17366 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17367 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17370 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17371 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17372 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17373 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17374 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17375 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17376 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17377 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17378 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17380 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17381 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17382 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17383 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17387 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17388 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17389 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17390 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17392 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17393 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17394 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17395 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17396 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17397 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17398 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17399 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17400 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17401 the router is skipped.
17403 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17404 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17405 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17406 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17407 setting to achieve this. For example:
17409 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17411 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17412 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17413 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17417 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17418 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17419 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17420 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17421 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17422 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17423 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17424 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17426 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17427 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17429 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17430 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17432 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17433 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17434 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17436 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17438 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17440 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17443 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17445 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17446 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17450 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17451 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17452 be specified using &%condition%&.
17454 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17455 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17456 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17457 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17458 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17459 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17460 Router rules processing behavior.
17462 This is best illustrated in an example:
17464 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17465 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17467 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17470 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17473 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17474 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17475 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17476 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17477 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17478 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17479 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17480 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17482 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17483 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17484 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17485 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17488 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17489 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17490 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17491 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17492 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17495 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17496 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17497 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17498 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17499 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17500 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17501 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17502 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17503 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17504 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17505 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17506 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17507 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17508 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17512 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17513 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17514 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17515 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17516 transport option of the same name.
17518 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17519 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17520 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17521 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17522 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17523 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17524 the dnssec request bit set.
17525 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17527 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17528 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17529 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17530 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17531 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17532 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17533 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17534 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17535 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17538 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17539 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17540 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17541 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17542 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17543 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17544 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17545 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17549 .option driver routers string unset
17550 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17554 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17555 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17556 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17557 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17558 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17559 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17560 Not effective on redirect routers.
17564 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17565 .cindex "envelope sender"
17566 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17567 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17568 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17569 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17570 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17571 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17572 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17574 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17575 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17576 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17579 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17580 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17581 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17582 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17584 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17585 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17586 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17587 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17593 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17594 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17595 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17596 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17597 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17599 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17600 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17601 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17602 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17603 setting &%return_path%&.
17605 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17606 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17607 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17611 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17612 .cindex "address" "testing"
17613 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17614 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17615 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17616 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17617 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17618 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17619 on for the system alias file.
17620 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17623 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17624 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17625 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17629 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17630 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17631 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17632 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17636 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17637 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17638 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17642 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17643 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17644 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17648 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17649 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17650 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17651 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17652 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17653 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17654 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17655 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17656 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17658 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17659 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17660 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17661 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17662 transport for further details.
17665 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17666 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17667 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17668 .cindex "transport" "local"
17669 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17670 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17671 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17673 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17674 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17675 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17676 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17677 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17681 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17682 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17683 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17684 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17685 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17686 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17687 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17688 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17689 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17690 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17691 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17692 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17693 &"see"& the added header lines.
17695 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17696 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17697 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17698 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17700 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17701 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17703 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17704 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17706 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17707 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17708 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17709 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17710 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17711 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17712 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17713 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17714 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17715 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17719 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17720 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17721 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17722 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17723 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17724 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17725 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17726 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17727 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17728 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17729 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17730 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17731 &"see"& the original header lines.
17733 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17734 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17735 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17738 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17739 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17741 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17742 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17744 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17745 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17746 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17747 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17749 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17750 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17751 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17755 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17756 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17757 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17758 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17759 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17760 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17761 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17764 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17768 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17770 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17771 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17772 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17773 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17774 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17775 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17777 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17778 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17780 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17781 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17783 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17784 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17786 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17787 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17788 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17789 domain that is being routed.
17791 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17792 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17795 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17796 .cindex "additional groups"
17797 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17798 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17799 .cindex "transport" "local"
17800 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17801 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17802 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17803 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17804 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17808 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17809 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17810 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17811 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17812 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17813 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17816 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17817 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17818 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17819 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17820 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17821 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17822 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17823 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17824 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17826 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17827 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17828 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17829 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17830 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17831 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17832 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17833 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17834 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17835 the relevant transport.
17837 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17838 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17839 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17842 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17843 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17844 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17845 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17846 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17850 local_part_prefix = real-
17852 transport = local_delivery
17854 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17855 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17857 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17858 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17861 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17862 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17863 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17864 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17867 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17868 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17872 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17873 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17874 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17875 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17876 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17877 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17878 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17879 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17880 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17884 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17885 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17889 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17890 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17891 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17892 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17893 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17895 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17896 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17899 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17901 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17902 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17903 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17904 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17905 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17906 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17907 each virtual domain:
17911 local_parts = postmaster
17912 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17916 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17917 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17918 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17919 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17920 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17921 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17922 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17923 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17924 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17925 redirect addresses.
17929 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17930 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17931 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17932 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17933 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17934 delivery to be deferred.
17936 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17937 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17939 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17940 means of the setting
17944 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17945 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17946 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17948 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17949 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17950 controls what happens next.
17953 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17954 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17955 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17956 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17957 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17958 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17959 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17960 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17962 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17963 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17964 applies to all of them.
17968 .option pass_router routers string unset
17969 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17970 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17971 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17972 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17973 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17974 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17975 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17976 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17977 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17978 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17982 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17983 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17984 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17985 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17986 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17987 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17989 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17990 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17991 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17992 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17996 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17997 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17998 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17999 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18000 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18001 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18002 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18004 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18005 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18006 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18007 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18009 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18010 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18011 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18012 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18013 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18016 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18017 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18020 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18021 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18022 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18023 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18024 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18025 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18026 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18027 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18029 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18030 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18031 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18032 operates as follows:
18034 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18035 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18036 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18037 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18040 require_files = mail:/some/file
18041 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18043 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18044 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18046 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18047 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18048 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18049 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18051 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18052 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18053 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18054 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18055 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18057 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18058 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18059 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18060 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18061 check again in that process.
18063 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18064 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18065 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18066 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18067 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18068 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18069 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18071 require_files = +/some/file
18073 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18074 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18075 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18079 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18080 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18081 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18082 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18083 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18084 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18085 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18086 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18089 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18090 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18091 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18092 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18093 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18096 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18097 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18098 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18102 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18103 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18104 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18106 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18107 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18108 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18109 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18110 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18111 cause the router to defer.
18113 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18114 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18116 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18118 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18119 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18121 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18122 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18123 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18124 of these values that is set:
18127 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18129 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18131 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18133 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18136 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18137 router, but not for the transport.
18141 .option self routers string freeze
18142 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18143 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18144 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18145 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18146 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18147 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18149 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18150 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18151 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18152 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18153 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18155 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18156 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18157 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18158 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18159 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18164 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18166 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18167 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18168 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18169 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18171 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18172 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18173 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18178 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18179 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18180 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18181 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18182 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18183 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18189 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18190 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18191 be passed to the next router.
18194 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18197 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18198 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18199 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18200 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18201 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18202 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18207 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18208 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18209 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18210 address matches something on the list.
18211 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18214 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18215 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18216 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18217 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18218 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18219 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18220 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18224 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18225 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18226 .cindex "packet radio"
18227 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18228 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18229 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18230 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18231 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18232 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18233 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18234 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18236 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18237 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18238 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18239 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18240 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18241 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18242 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18243 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18244 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18245 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18247 translate_ip_address = \
18248 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18251 The file would contain lines like
18253 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18254 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18256 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18261 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18262 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18263 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18264 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18265 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18266 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18267 delivery is deferred.
18269 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18270 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18271 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18275 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18276 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18277 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18278 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18279 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18280 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18281 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18282 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18283 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18284 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18285 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18291 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18292 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18293 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18294 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18295 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18296 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18297 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18298 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18299 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18300 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18302 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18303 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18304 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18305 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18306 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18308 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18314 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18315 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18316 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18317 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18318 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18319 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18320 delivery to be deferred.
18322 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18323 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18324 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18325 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18326 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18327 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18329 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18330 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18331 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18332 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18333 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18334 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18335 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18336 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18338 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18339 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18340 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18341 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18342 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18343 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18344 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18345 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18346 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18347 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18349 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18350 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18351 subsequent routers.
18354 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18355 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18356 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18357 .cindex "transport" "local"
18358 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18359 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18360 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18361 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18362 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18363 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18364 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18365 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18366 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18367 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18368 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18369 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18373 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18374 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18375 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18378 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18379 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18381 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18382 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18383 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18384 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18385 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18386 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18387 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18389 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18390 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18391 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18395 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18396 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18398 delivering in cutthrough mode
18399 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18400 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18402 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18405 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18406 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18407 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18408 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18410 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18411 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18412 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18422 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18423 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18424 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18425 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18426 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18427 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18428 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18429 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18430 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18434 domains = mydomain.example
18436 transport = local_delivery
18438 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18439 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18440 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18441 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18448 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18449 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18451 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18452 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18453 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18454 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18455 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18456 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18458 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18459 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18460 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18461 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18464 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18465 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18466 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18467 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18468 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18469 generic option, the router declines.
18471 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18472 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18473 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18475 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18476 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18477 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18478 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18479 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18480 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18483 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18484 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18485 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18486 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18487 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18488 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18490 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18491 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18492 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18493 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18494 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18495 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18496 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18497 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18498 case routing fails.
18501 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18502 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18503 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18504 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18505 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18507 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18508 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18510 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18512 The domain does not exist in DNS
18514 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18515 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18516 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18518 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18520 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18522 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18523 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18525 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18526 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18528 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18529 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18531 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18532 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18538 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18539 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18540 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18542 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18543 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18544 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18545 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18546 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18547 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18548 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18551 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18552 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18553 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18554 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18555 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18556 required. For example,
18560 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18561 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18562 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18563 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18564 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18567 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18568 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18569 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18570 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18571 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18572 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18574 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18575 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18576 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18577 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18578 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18579 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18580 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18581 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18583 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18584 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18589 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18590 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18591 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18592 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18593 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18594 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18595 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18596 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18600 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18601 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18602 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18603 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18604 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18605 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18606 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18609 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18611 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18612 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18613 the address record.
18616 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18617 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18618 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18619 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18624 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18625 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18626 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18627 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18628 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18629 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18630 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18631 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18632 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18637 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18638 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18639 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18640 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18641 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18642 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18643 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18644 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18645 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18646 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18647 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18649 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18650 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18653 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18654 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18655 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18656 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18657 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18661 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18662 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18663 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18664 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18665 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18666 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18667 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18668 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18670 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18671 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18672 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18673 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18674 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18675 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18676 without processing them independently,
18677 provided the following conditions are met:
18680 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18681 &%headers_remove%&.
18683 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18690 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18691 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18692 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18693 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18694 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18695 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18696 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18697 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18698 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18699 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18701 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18702 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18707 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18708 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18709 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18710 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18715 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18716 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18717 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18718 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18721 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18723 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18724 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18725 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18726 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18727 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18728 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18731 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18732 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18733 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18734 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18735 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18737 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18738 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18739 such as that implied by
18743 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18744 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18745 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18746 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18756 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18757 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18759 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18760 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18761 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18762 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18763 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18764 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18765 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18766 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18767 router handles the address
18771 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18772 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18773 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18775 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18777 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18778 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18780 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18781 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18782 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18783 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18785 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18786 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18787 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18788 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18795 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18796 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18797 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18798 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18799 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18800 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18803 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18805 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18807 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18808 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18809 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18810 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18811 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18812 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18813 must not be specified for it.
18815 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18816 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18817 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18818 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18819 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18820 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18821 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18824 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18825 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18826 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18827 delivery to the address is deferred.
18830 .option port iplookup integer 0
18831 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18832 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18836 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18837 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18838 protocols is to be used.
18841 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18842 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18845 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18847 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18848 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18851 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18852 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18853 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18854 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18855 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18856 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18857 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18858 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18861 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18862 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18863 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18864 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18865 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18866 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18867 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18868 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18869 following could be used:
18871 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18872 reroute = $local_part@$1
18875 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18876 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18877 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18878 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18883 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18884 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18886 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18887 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18888 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18889 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18890 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18891 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18892 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18893 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18894 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18895 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18897 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18898 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18899 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18900 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18901 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18902 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18903 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18906 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18907 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18908 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18909 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18910 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18911 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18912 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18915 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18916 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18917 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18918 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18919 below, following the list of private options.
18922 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18924 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18925 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18927 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18928 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18930 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18931 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18932 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18933 of the following values:
18942 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18943 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18944 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18947 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18948 router only if &%more%& is true.
18950 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18951 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18952 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18953 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18955 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18956 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18957 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18960 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18961 .cindex "randomized host list"
18962 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18963 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18964 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18965 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18966 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18967 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18968 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18969 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18971 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18972 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18973 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18974 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18976 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18978 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18979 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18980 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18981 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18982 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18985 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18986 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18987 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18990 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18992 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18993 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18997 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18998 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18999 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19000 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19003 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19004 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19005 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19006 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19007 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19008 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19009 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19010 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19012 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19013 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19014 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19015 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19016 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19017 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19018 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19019 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19024 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19025 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19026 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19027 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19028 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19029 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19031 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19033 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19037 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19038 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19040 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19041 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19042 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19043 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19044 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19045 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19046 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19047 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19048 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19049 in a &%route_list%&).
19051 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19052 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19053 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19054 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19058 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19059 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19060 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19061 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19062 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19063 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19064 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19067 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19068 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19070 This data can be accessed by setting
19072 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19074 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19075 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19076 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19077 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19078 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19083 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19084 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19085 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19086 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19087 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19088 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19089 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19091 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19092 variables are set during its expansion:
19095 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19096 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19097 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19099 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19102 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19104 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19107 .vindex "&$value$&"
19108 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19109 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19111 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19115 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19116 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19120 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19121 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19122 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19123 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19124 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19125 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19128 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19129 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19130 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19132 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19133 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19136 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19137 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19138 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19139 number follows. For example:
19141 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19145 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19146 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19147 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19148 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19149 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19152 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19153 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19154 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19155 records in the DNS. For example:
19157 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19159 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19162 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19164 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19165 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19166 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19167 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19168 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19169 happens is controlled by the
19170 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19171 &%self%& option of the router.
19173 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19174 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19175 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19176 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19177 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19178 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19179 defined by MX preferences.
19181 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19182 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19183 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19185 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19186 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19187 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19188 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19190 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19191 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19194 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19195 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19196 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19198 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19199 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19203 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19204 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
19205 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19206 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19207 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19208 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19209 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19212 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19213 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19215 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19216 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19218 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19219 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19220 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19222 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19223 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19224 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19229 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19230 domain2 host4:host5
19232 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19233 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19234 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19235 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19238 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19239 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19240 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19241 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19246 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19247 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19250 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19251 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19255 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19256 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19257 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19260 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19261 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19262 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19263 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19265 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19267 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19268 your first router something like this:
19271 driver = manualroute
19272 domains = !+local_domains
19273 transport = remote_smtp
19274 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19276 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19277 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19278 they are tried in order
19279 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19280 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19283 driver = manualroute
19284 transport = remote_smtp
19285 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19287 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19288 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19289 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19290 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19291 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19292 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19293 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19294 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19297 .cindex "mail hub example"
19298 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19299 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19300 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19301 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19302 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19303 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19304 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19305 lookup is easier to manage.
19307 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19308 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19312 driver = manualroute
19313 transport = remote_smtp
19314 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19316 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19317 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19318 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19319 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19320 domain can be used to find the host:
19323 driver = manualroute
19324 transport = remote_smtp
19325 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19327 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19328 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19329 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19333 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19334 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19335 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19336 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19337 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19338 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19341 driver = manualroute
19342 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19343 route_list = saved.domain.example
19345 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19346 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19347 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19350 driver = manualroute
19352 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19353 *.saved.domain2.example \
19354 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19357 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19359 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19360 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19361 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19362 the address if the lookup fails.
19365 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19366 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19367 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19368 one way it can be done:
19374 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19375 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19376 return_fail_output = true
19381 driver = manualroute
19383 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19385 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19387 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19389 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19390 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19391 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19393 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19394 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19406 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19407 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19408 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19409 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19410 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19411 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19412 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19413 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19414 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19415 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19417 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19419 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19420 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19421 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19422 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19423 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19426 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19427 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19428 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19429 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19430 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19431 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19434 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19435 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19436 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19437 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19438 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19439 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19440 not set, a value for the gid also.
19442 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19443 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19444 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19445 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19446 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19447 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19451 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19452 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19453 before running the command.
19456 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19457 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19458 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19462 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19463 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19464 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19465 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19466 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19469 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19472 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19473 &%no_more%& is set.
19475 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19476 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19477 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19478 included in the SMTP response.
19480 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19481 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19482 included in any SMTP response.
19484 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19486 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19487 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19489 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19490 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19491 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19494 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19495 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19498 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19499 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19501 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19502 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19503 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19504 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19506 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19507 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19508 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19509 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19510 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19512 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19513 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19514 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19515 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19516 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19518 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19519 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19520 variable. For example, this return line
19522 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19524 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19525 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19526 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19527 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19532 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19535 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19536 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19537 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19538 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19539 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19540 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19541 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19542 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19543 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19544 redirected in several different ways:
19547 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19550 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19552 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19554 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19556 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19558 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19560 It can be discarded.
19563 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19564 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19565 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19566 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19568 If success DSNs have been requested
19569 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19570 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19571 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19575 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19576 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19577 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19578 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19579 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19580 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19584 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19586 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19587 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19588 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19589 cause delivery to be deferred.
19591 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19592 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19597 file = $home/.forward
19600 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19601 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19602 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19603 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19608 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19609 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19610 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19611 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19614 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19615 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19616 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19617 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19619 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19620 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19621 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19622 saves some resources.
19630 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19631 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19632 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19633 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19634 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19637 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19638 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19639 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19640 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19641 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19642 document is intended for use by end users.
19644 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19645 described in the next section.
19648 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19649 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19650 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19651 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19652 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19656 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19657 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19658 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19659 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19660 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19661 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19662 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19663 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19664 commas or newlines.
19665 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19668 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19669 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19670 next newline character is ignored.
19672 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19673 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19674 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19675 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19678 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19679 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19680 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19681 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19682 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19683 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19686 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19690 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19691 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19692 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19693 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19694 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19695 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19696 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19697 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19698 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19699 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19700 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19702 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19703 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19704 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19705 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19706 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19708 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19710 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19711 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19712 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19713 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19714 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19717 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19718 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19719 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19720 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19721 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19723 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19724 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19729 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19730 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19733 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19735 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19736 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19737 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19738 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19739 should really contain
19741 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19743 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19744 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19745 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19749 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19750 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19751 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19754 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19755 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19756 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19757 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19758 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19759 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19760 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19762 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19763 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19764 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19765 in double quotes, for example:
19767 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19769 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19770 quote just the command. An item such as
19772 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19774 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19776 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19777 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19778 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19779 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19780 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19781 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19782 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19783 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19784 an &%accept%& router.
19787 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19788 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19789 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19790 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19792 /home/world/minbari
19794 is treated as a file name, but
19796 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19798 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19799 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19800 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19801 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19803 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19804 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19806 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19807 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19808 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19809 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19812 .cindex "included address list"
19813 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19814 If an item is of the form
19816 :include:<path name>
19818 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19819 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19820 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19821 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19822 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19823 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19825 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19827 It must be given as
19829 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19832 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19833 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19834 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19835 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19836 .cindex "black hole"
19837 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19838 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19839 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19840 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19842 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19843 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19844 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19845 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19849 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19850 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19851 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19852 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19853 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19854 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19855 redirection items of the form
19860 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19861 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19862 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19863 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19865 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19867 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19869 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19870 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19872 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19873 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19874 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19876 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19877 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19878 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19879 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19880 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19881 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19882 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19883 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19884 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19887 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19888 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19889 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19890 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19892 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19893 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19894 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19895 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19896 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19898 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19899 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19900 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19901 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19902 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19906 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19907 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19908 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19909 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19910 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19911 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19912 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19916 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19917 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19918 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19919 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19920 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19921 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19922 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19923 aliasing scheme of the type
19925 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19929 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19930 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19931 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19934 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19935 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19937 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19938 the pipes are distinct.
19942 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19943 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19944 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19945 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19946 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19947 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19948 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19949 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19950 can be used to avoid this.
19953 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19954 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19955 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19956 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19957 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19958 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19959 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19963 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19965 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19966 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19969 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19970 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19971 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19974 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19975 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19976 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19977 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19980 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19981 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19982 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19983 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19984 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19985 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19986 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19988 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19989 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19992 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19993 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19994 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19995 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19996 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20000 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20001 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20002 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20003 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20004 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20005 let ordinary users do.
20009 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20010 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20011 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20012 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20013 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20014 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20016 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20017 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20018 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20019 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20020 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20021 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20023 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20025 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20026 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20027 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20028 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20029 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20030 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20031 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20032 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20035 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20036 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20037 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20038 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20039 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20040 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20041 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20042 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20046 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20047 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20048 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20049 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20050 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20051 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20054 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20055 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20056 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20057 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20058 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20059 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20061 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20062 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20063 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20065 data = #Exim filter\n\
20066 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20068 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20069 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20070 choice into a newline.
20073 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20074 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20075 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20076 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20077 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20080 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20081 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20082 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20083 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20084 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20085 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20086 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20087 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20089 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20090 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20091 runs a check on the containing directory,
20092 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20093 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20094 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20095 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20096 not, the router declines.
20099 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20100 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20101 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20102 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20103 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20104 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20105 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20108 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20109 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20110 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20111 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20112 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20115 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20116 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20120 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20121 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20122 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20127 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20128 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20129 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20130 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20131 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20132 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20133 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20134 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20135 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20138 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20139 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20140 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20141 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20144 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20145 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20146 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20147 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20149 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20150 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20151 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20152 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20153 &_.forward_& files).
20156 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20157 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20158 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20161 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20162 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20163 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20164 of the embedded Perl support.
20167 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20168 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20169 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20172 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20173 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20174 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20177 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20178 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20179 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20180 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20181 &%one_time%& is set.
20184 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20185 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20186 to make use of &%run%& items.
20189 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20190 If this option is true, items of the form
20192 :include:<path name>
20194 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20197 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20198 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20199 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20200 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20201 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20204 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20205 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20206 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20209 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20210 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20211 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20212 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20213 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20218 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20219 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20220 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20221 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20222 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20223 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20224 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20227 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20229 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20230 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20231 file did not exist.
20234 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20236 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20237 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20238 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20240 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20241 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20242 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20243 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20244 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20245 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20246 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20247 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20251 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20252 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20253 redirection list must start with this directory.
20256 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20257 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20258 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20261 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20262 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20263 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20264 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20265 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20266 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20267 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20268 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20269 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20270 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20271 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20272 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20273 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20274 before they subscribed.
20276 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20277 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20278 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20279 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20282 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20283 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20284 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20285 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20287 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20288 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20289 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20291 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20294 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20295 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20296 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20297 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20298 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20302 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20303 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20304 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20305 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20306 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20307 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20308 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20309 See &%check_owner%& above.
20312 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20313 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20314 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20315 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20318 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20319 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20320 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20321 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20322 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20323 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20324 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20327 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20328 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20329 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20330 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20331 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20332 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20333 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20334 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20336 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20337 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20338 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20341 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20342 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20343 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20344 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20345 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20346 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20347 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20348 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20349 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20350 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20353 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20354 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20355 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20356 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20357 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20358 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20361 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20362 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20363 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20364 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20365 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20366 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20369 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20370 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20371 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20372 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20373 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20376 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20377 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20378 :subaddress part of an address.
20380 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20381 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20382 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20383 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20386 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20387 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20388 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20389 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20390 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20391 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20392 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20396 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20397 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20398 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20399 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20400 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20401 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20402 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20403 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20404 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20405 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20406 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20407 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20408 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20409 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20410 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20411 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20413 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20414 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20415 the following routers.
20417 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20418 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20419 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20420 so it is passed to the following routers.
20422 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20423 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20424 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20425 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20427 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20428 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20429 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20430 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20436 file = $home/.forward
20437 file_transport = address_file
20438 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20439 reply_transport = address_reply
20442 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20443 syntax_errors_text = \
20444 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20445 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20446 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20447 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20448 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20449 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20450 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20451 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20452 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20453 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20455 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20456 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20457 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20462 local_part_prefix = real-
20463 transport = local_delivery
20465 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20466 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20468 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20469 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20473 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20474 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20477 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20478 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20479 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20480 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20490 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20491 "Environment for local transports"
20492 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20493 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20494 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20495 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20496 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20497 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20498 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20500 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20501 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20502 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20503 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20505 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20506 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20507 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20508 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20509 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20513 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20514 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20515 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20516 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20517 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20518 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20519 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20522 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20523 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20527 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20529 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20530 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20531 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20532 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20537 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20538 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20539 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20540 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20541 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20542 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20543 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20544 group (set by the transport). For example:
20547 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20551 transport = group_delivery
20554 # This transport overrides the group
20556 driver = appendfile
20557 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20560 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20561 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20562 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20565 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20566 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20567 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20568 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20569 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20570 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20572 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20573 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20574 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20575 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20576 original gid is also used.
20578 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20579 following that is set is used:
20582 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20584 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20586 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20587 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20589 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20591 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20592 the uid is the creator's uid;
20594 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20597 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20598 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20599 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20600 The first of the following that is set is used:
20603 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20605 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20607 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20609 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20614 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20615 &%never_users%& list.
20621 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20622 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20623 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20624 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20625 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20626 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20627 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20628 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20629 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20630 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20633 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20635 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20637 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20639 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20642 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20645 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20647 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20651 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20652 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20653 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20657 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20658 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20659 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20660 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20661 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20662 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20663 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20664 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20665 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20666 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20667 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20668 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20669 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20670 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20681 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20682 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20683 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20684 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20685 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20688 .option body_only transports boolean false
20689 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20690 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20691 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20692 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20693 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20694 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20695 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20696 automatically suppress them.
20699 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20700 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20701 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20702 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20703 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20704 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20707 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20708 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20709 deliveries by the transport or for any
20710 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20711 what you are doing.
20714 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20715 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20716 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20717 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20719 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20720 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20721 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20722 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20723 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20724 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20726 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20727 transport and the router that called it.
20729 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20730 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20731 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20732 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20733 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20734 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20735 safely be resent to other recipients.
20738 .option driver transports string unset
20739 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20740 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20743 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20744 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20745 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20746 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20747 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20748 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20749 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20750 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20751 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20752 resent to other recipients.
20755 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
20757 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
20758 For details see &<<CHAPevents>>&.
20762 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20763 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20764 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20765 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20766 &%user%& (see below).
20769 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20770 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20771 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20772 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20773 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20774 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20775 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20776 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20777 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20778 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20779 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20781 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20782 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20785 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20786 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20787 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20788 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20789 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20790 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20791 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20792 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20795 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20796 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20797 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20798 This option specifies a list of header names,
20799 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20800 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20801 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20803 Each list item is separately expanded.
20804 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20805 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20806 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20808 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20809 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20811 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20812 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20813 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20817 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20818 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20819 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20820 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20821 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20822 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20823 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20824 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20827 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20830 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20831 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20832 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20833 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20834 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20835 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20836 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20837 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20838 change envelope recipients at this time.
20841 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20842 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20844 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20845 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20846 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20847 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20848 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20849 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20850 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20854 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20855 .cindex "additional groups"
20856 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20857 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20858 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20859 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20860 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20864 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20865 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20866 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
20867 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20868 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20869 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20870 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20871 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20873 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20874 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20875 incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20876 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20877 Obviously there is scope for
20878 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20879 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20881 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20882 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20883 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20884 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20885 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20889 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20890 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20891 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20892 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20893 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20894 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20895 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20896 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20897 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20898 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20899 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20900 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20901 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20906 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20907 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20908 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20909 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20910 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20911 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20912 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20913 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20916 local_part_prefix = *-
20918 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20921 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20923 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20924 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20925 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20926 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20927 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20930 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20931 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20932 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20933 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20934 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20935 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20936 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20937 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20938 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20940 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20941 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20942 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20943 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20945 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20946 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20947 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20950 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20951 .cindex "envelope sender"
20952 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20953 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20954 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20955 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20956 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20957 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20958 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20959 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20960 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20962 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20963 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20965 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20966 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20967 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20968 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20969 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20970 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20971 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20973 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20974 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20975 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20976 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20977 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20981 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20982 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20983 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20984 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20985 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20986 have easy access to it.
20988 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20989 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20990 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20991 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20992 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20996 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20997 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21000 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21001 .cindex "shadow transport"
21002 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21003 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21004 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21006 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21007 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21008 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21009 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21010 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21011 cause a log line to be written.
21013 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21014 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21015 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21016 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21017 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21020 ST=<shadow transport name>
21022 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21023 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21024 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21025 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21026 headers that some sites insist on.
21029 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21030 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21031 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21032 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21033 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21034 individual users or via a system filter.
21036 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21039 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21040 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21041 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21042 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21043 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21045 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21046 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21047 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21048 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21049 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21050 &(pipe)& transports.
21052 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21053 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21054 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21055 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21056 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21058 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21059 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21060 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21061 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21063 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21064 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21065 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21066 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21067 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21068 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21070 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21071 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21072 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21073 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21074 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21075 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21076 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21077 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21079 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21080 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21081 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21082 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21083 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21084 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21085 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21086 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21087 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21088 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21091 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21092 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21093 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21094 which the message is being sent. For example:
21096 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21097 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21100 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21101 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21102 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21104 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21105 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21106 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21109 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21111 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21112 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21113 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21114 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21115 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21116 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21118 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21119 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21120 arguments. Consider this example:
21122 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21123 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21125 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21126 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21128 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21129 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21133 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21134 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21135 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21136 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21137 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21138 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21139 bounced from a transport filter.
21141 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21142 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21143 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21146 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21147 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21148 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21149 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21150 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21151 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21152 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21153 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21154 becomes a temporary error.
21157 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21158 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21159 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21160 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21161 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21162 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21163 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21166 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21167 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21168 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21170 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21171 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21172 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21173 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21175 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21176 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21177 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21184 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21187 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21189 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21190 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21191 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21192 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21193 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21194 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21195 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21197 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21198 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21199 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21200 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21201 local transport, for example:
21204 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21205 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21206 recipients saves space.
21208 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21209 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21211 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21212 to a scanner program or
21213 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21217 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21218 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21219 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21221 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21222 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21223 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21224 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21225 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21226 to certain conditions:
21229 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21230 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21231 batching is possible.
21233 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21234 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21235 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21237 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21238 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21239 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21240 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21241 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21244 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21245 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21246 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21250 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21251 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21252 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21253 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21254 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21255 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21256 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21259 escape_string = ".."
21261 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21262 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21263 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21265 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21266 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21267 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21268 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21269 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21270 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21272 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21273 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21274 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21275 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21276 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21277 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21278 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21279 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21280 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21285 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21286 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21288 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21289 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21290 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21291 .cindex "directory creation"
21292 .cindex "creating directories"
21293 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21294 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21295 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21296 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21297 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21298 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21299 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21300 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21301 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21302 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21304 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21305 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21306 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21309 .cindex "quota" "system"
21310 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21311 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21312 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21314 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21315 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21316 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21317 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21319 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21320 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21323 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21324 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21325 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21326 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21331 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21332 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21333 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21334 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21335 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21337 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21338 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21339 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21340 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21341 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21342 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21343 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21344 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21345 operation. There are two cases:
21348 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21349 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21350 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21351 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21352 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21353 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21354 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21356 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21357 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21358 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21362 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21363 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21364 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21365 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21370 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21372 require "fileinto";
21373 fileinto "folder23";
21375 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21376 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21377 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21378 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21379 way of handling this requirement:
21381 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21382 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21383 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21385 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21389 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21390 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21391 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21393 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21394 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21395 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21396 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21397 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21398 path to the transport.
21400 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21401 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21406 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21407 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21411 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21412 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21413 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21414 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21415 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21416 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21417 delivery is deferred.
21420 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21421 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21422 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21423 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21424 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21425 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21426 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21427 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21430 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21431 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21432 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21433 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21437 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21438 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21441 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21442 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21443 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21444 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21445 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21448 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21449 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21450 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21451 process is running.
21454 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21455 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21456 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21457 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21458 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21459 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21460 contains is significant.
21462 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21463 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21464 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21465 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21466 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21468 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21469 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21470 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21471 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21472 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21473 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21475 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21476 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21477 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21478 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21480 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21481 .cindex "directory creation"
21482 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21483 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21484 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21486 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21487 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21488 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21489 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21490 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21494 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21495 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21496 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21497 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21498 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21501 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21502 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21503 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21504 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21505 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21506 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21507 &%file_must_exist%&.
21510 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21511 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21512 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21513 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21515 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21516 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21517 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21518 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21519 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21522 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21524 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21525 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21526 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21527 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21529 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21531 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21532 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21536 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21537 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21538 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21541 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21542 See &%check_string%& above.
21545 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21546 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21547 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21548 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21549 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21550 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21553 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21554 .cindex "locking files"
21555 .cindex "lock files"
21556 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21557 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21559 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21560 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21563 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21564 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21567 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21568 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21569 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21570 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21571 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21572 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21576 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21577 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21578 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21579 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21580 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21581 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21582 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21583 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21584 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21587 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21588 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21590 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21591 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21592 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21593 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21594 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21595 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21596 delivery is deferred.
21599 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21600 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21601 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21602 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21605 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21606 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21607 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21608 .cindex "locking files"
21609 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21610 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21611 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21612 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21613 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21614 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21615 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21616 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21618 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21619 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21620 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21621 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21623 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21624 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21627 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21629 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21630 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21631 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21633 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21634 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21636 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21639 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21640 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21641 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21642 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21645 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21646 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21647 for details of locking.
21650 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21651 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21652 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21655 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21656 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21657 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21660 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21661 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21662 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21663 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21664 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21667 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21668 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21669 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21670 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21671 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21672 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21673 external source that maintains the data.
21676 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21677 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21678 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21679 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21680 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21681 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21682 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21683 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21687 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21688 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21689 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21690 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21691 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21692 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21693 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21694 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21695 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21696 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21699 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21700 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21701 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21702 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21703 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21704 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21705 calculation. The default value is:
21707 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21709 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21710 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21712 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21714 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21716 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21717 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21718 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21719 directly into that directory.
21722 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21723 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21724 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21727 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21728 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21729 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21732 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21733 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21734 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21735 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21736 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21737 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21738 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21739 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21741 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21742 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21743 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21744 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21745 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21746 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21747 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21748 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21749 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21750 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21753 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21754 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21755 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21756 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21757 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21758 below for further details.
21761 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21762 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21763 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21766 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21767 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21768 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21771 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21772 .cindex "locking files"
21773 .cindex "file" "locking"
21774 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21775 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21776 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21777 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21778 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21779 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21780 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21782 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21783 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21784 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21791 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21792 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21793 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21794 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21795 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21796 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21797 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21798 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21800 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21801 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21802 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21803 append messages to it.
21806 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21807 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21808 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21809 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21810 in which case it is:
21812 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21813 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21815 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21816 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21818 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21819 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21820 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21821 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21826 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21827 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21829 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21830 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21831 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21832 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21833 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21834 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21835 value, and this option is ignored.
21838 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21839 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21840 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21841 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21842 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21845 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21846 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21847 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21848 on users about incoming mail.
21851 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21852 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21853 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21854 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21855 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21856 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21857 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21858 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21859 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21861 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21862 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21863 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21865 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21866 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21867 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21868 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21869 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21870 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21872 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21873 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21874 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21875 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21878 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21880 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21881 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21882 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21883 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21884 system quota failures.
21886 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21887 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21888 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21889 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21890 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21891 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21892 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21893 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21894 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21895 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21898 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21899 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21900 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21901 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21902 delivery directory.
21905 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21906 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21907 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21908 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21909 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21913 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21914 See &%quota%& above.
21917 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21918 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21919 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21920 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21921 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21922 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21923 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21925 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21926 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21927 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21928 the file length to the file name. For example:
21930 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21931 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21933 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21934 number of lines in the message.
21936 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21937 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21938 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21940 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21943 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21944 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21945 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21947 quota_warn_message = "\
21948 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21949 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21950 This message is automatically created \
21951 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21952 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21953 a warning threshold that is\n\
21954 set by the system administrator.\n"
21958 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21959 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21960 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21961 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21962 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21963 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21964 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21965 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21966 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21970 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21972 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21973 percent sign is ignored.
21975 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21976 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21977 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21978 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21979 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21980 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21982 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21984 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21985 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21988 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21989 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21993 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21994 .cindex "envelope sender"
21995 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21996 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21997 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21998 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21999 for details of batch SMTP.
22002 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22003 .cindex "carriage return"
22005 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22006 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22007 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22008 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22010 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22011 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22012 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22013 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22014 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22015 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22018 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22019 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22020 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22021 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22022 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22023 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22026 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22027 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22028 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22029 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22030 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22032 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22033 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22034 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22035 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22037 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22038 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22039 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22040 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22041 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22044 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22045 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22048 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22049 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22050 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22051 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22052 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22053 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22054 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22056 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22057 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22058 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22059 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22062 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22063 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22064 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22067 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22068 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22069 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22070 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22071 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22072 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22073 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22074 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22075 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22077 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22078 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22079 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22080 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22085 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22086 .cindex "appending to a file"
22087 .cindex "file" "appending"
22088 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22091 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22095 .cindex "directory creation"
22096 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22097 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22098 &%directory_mode%& option.
22101 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22102 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22106 .cindex "file" "locking"
22107 .cindex "locking files"
22108 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22109 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22110 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22113 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22114 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22115 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22117 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22119 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22120 Unlink the hitching post name.
22122 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22123 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22124 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22125 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22127 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22128 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22129 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22130 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22131 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22132 it before trying again.
22136 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22137 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22138 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22141 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22142 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22143 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22144 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22145 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22146 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22147 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22148 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22149 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22153 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22154 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22155 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22156 delivery is deferred.
22159 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22160 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22161 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22165 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22166 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22167 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22170 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22171 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22172 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22175 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22176 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22177 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22178 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22179 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22180 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22181 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22182 that prevents link following.
22185 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22186 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22187 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22188 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22189 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22192 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22195 .cindex "file" "locking"
22196 .cindex "locking files"
22197 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22198 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22199 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22200 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22201 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22203 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22205 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22206 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22207 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22209 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22210 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22211 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22213 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22214 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22215 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22216 delivery is deferred.
22218 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22219 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22220 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22221 immediately. It retries up to
22223 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22225 times (rounded up).
22228 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22229 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22232 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22233 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22234 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22235 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22236 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22237 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22238 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22239 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22240 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22241 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22243 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22244 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22245 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22246 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22247 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22248 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22249 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22251 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22252 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22253 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22254 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22257 .cindex "maildir format"
22258 .cindex "mailstore format"
22259 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22260 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22261 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22262 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22263 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22265 .cindex "directory creation"
22266 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22267 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22268 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22269 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22270 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22271 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22276 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22277 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22278 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22279 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22280 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22281 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22282 &_new_& subdirectory.
22284 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22285 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22286 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22287 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22288 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22289 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22290 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22292 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22293 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22294 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22295 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22296 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22297 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22298 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22299 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22301 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22302 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22303 folders. Consider this example:
22305 maildir_format = true
22306 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22307 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22308 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22309 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22311 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22312 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22313 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22314 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22315 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22316 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22318 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22319 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22320 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22321 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22322 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22324 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22325 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22326 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22328 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22329 .cindex "maildir++"
22330 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22331 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22332 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22333 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22334 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22335 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22336 amount of space used.
22338 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22339 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22340 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22341 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22342 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22343 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22348 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22349 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22350 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22351 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22352 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22353 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22356 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22357 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22358 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22359 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22360 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22361 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22362 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22363 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22364 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22365 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22366 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22367 backwards compatibility).
22369 For one common implementation, you might set:
22371 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22373 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22375 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22376 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22377 &[stat()]& each message file.
22380 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22381 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22382 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22383 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22384 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22385 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22386 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22387 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22388 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22390 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22391 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22392 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22393 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22394 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22395 need to know the quota.
22397 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22398 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22400 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22401 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22402 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22406 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22407 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22408 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22409 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22410 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22411 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22412 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22413 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22415 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22416 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22417 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22418 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22419 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22420 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22422 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22423 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22424 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22425 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22426 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22427 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22429 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22430 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22431 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22432 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22435 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22436 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22437 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22438 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22439 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22441 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22443 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22444 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22445 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22446 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22447 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22454 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22455 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22457 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22458 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22459 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22460 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22461 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22462 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22463 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22464 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22466 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22467 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22468 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22469 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22470 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22473 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22474 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22475 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22476 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22477 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22479 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22480 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22481 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22482 transport is run as a consequence of a
22484 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22485 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22486 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22487 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22488 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22489 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22491 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22492 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22493 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22494 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22496 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22497 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22498 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22499 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22500 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22501 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22502 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22504 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22505 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22506 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22507 the transport defers.
22508 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22509 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22511 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22512 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22513 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22514 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22516 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22517 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22518 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22519 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22520 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22521 problems. They are just discarded.
22525 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22526 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22528 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22529 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22530 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22533 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22534 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22535 when the message is specified by the transport.
22538 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22539 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22540 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22541 string comes first.
22544 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22545 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22546 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22549 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22550 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22551 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22554 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22555 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22556 specified by the transport.
22559 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22560 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22561 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22562 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22565 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22566 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22567 the message is specified by the transport.
22570 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22571 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22575 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22576 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22577 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22578 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22579 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22583 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22584 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22585 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22586 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22588 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22589 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22590 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22591 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22592 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22593 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22594 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22597 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22598 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22599 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22600 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22601 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22603 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22604 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22605 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22606 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22607 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22608 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22611 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22612 See &%once%& above.
22615 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22616 See &%once%& above.
22617 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22620 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22621 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22622 specified by the transport.
22625 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22626 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22627 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22628 configuration option.
22631 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22632 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22633 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22634 automatic responses. For example:
22636 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22638 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22639 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22640 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22641 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22646 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22647 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22648 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22649 the text comes first.
22652 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22653 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22654 when the message is specified by the transport.
22655 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22656 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22664 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22665 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22666 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22667 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22668 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22669 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22671 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22672 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22673 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22674 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22675 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22676 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22680 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22681 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22682 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22685 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22686 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22689 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22690 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22691 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22692 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22693 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22696 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22697 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22698 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22699 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22700 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22701 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22704 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22705 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22706 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22707 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22708 in its response to the LHLO command.
22710 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22711 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22712 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22713 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22716 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22717 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22718 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22719 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22724 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22728 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22729 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22736 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22737 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22738 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22739 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22740 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22741 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22742 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22743 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22747 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22748 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22749 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22750 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22751 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22753 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22754 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22755 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22756 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22757 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22758 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22759 that are routed to the transport.
22761 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22762 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22763 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22764 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22765 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22766 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22767 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22771 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22772 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22773 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22775 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22776 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22777 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22778 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22779 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22780 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22781 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22784 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22785 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22786 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22787 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22788 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22790 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22791 of "1" to enforce serialization.
22797 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22798 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22799 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22800 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22801 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22802 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22803 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22804 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22805 &"local delivery failed"&.
22807 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22808 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22809 will be sent as normal.
22811 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22812 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22813 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22814 apply in this case.
22816 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22817 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22818 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22819 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22821 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22822 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22823 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22824 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22825 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22826 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22827 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22832 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22833 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22834 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22835 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22836 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22839 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22840 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22841 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22842 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22844 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22845 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22846 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22847 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22848 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22850 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22852 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22853 arguments. You have to write
22855 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22857 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22858 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22859 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22860 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22861 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22862 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22865 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22868 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22869 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22870 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22871 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22872 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22873 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22874 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22875 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22876 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22877 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22879 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22880 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22881 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22882 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22883 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22884 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22885 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22886 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22888 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22889 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22890 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22891 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22892 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22893 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22894 control what is done with it.
22896 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22897 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22898 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22899 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22900 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22901 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22902 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22903 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22904 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22905 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22906 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22910 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22911 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22912 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
22913 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22914 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22915 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22916 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
22917 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
22919 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22920 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22921 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22922 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22923 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22924 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22925 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22926 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22927 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22928 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22929 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22930 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22931 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22932 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22933 &`USER `& see below
22935 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22936 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22937 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22938 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22939 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22940 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22941 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22944 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22945 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22946 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22950 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22951 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22952 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22953 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22956 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22957 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22961 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22962 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22963 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22964 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22965 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22966 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22967 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22968 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22969 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22970 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22971 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22974 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22976 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22977 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22978 &%use_shell%& is set.
22981 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22982 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22985 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22986 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22987 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22990 .option check_string pipe string unset
22991 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22992 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22993 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22994 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22995 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22996 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22997 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23001 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23002 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23003 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23004 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23005 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23006 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23007 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23010 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23011 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23012 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23013 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23014 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23015 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23016 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23019 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23020 See &%check_string%& above.
23023 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23024 .cindex "exec failure"
23025 .cindex "failure of exec"
23026 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23027 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23028 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23029 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23030 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23033 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23034 .cindex "signal exit"
23035 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23036 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23037 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23038 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23041 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23042 .cindex "force command"
23043 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23044 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23045 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23046 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23047 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23048 command. For example:
23050 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23054 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23055 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23056 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23059 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23060 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23061 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23062 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23063 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23064 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23066 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23067 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23070 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23071 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23072 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23073 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23074 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23075 written to the main log.
23078 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23079 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23080 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23081 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23082 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23083 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23087 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23088 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23089 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23090 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23091 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23094 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23095 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23096 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23097 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23098 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23099 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23100 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23101 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23104 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23105 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23106 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23109 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23113 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23114 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23115 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23116 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23117 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23122 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23123 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23126 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23127 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23128 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23129 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23133 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23134 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23137 .option path pipe string "see below"
23138 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23139 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
23143 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23144 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23145 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23148 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23149 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23150 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23151 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23152 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23153 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23154 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23155 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23156 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23159 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23160 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23161 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23162 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23163 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23164 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23165 accept the message is used.
23168 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23169 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23170 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23171 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23172 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23173 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23176 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23177 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23178 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23179 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23180 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23181 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23182 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23186 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23187 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23188 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23189 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23190 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23191 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23192 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23193 of them may be set.
23197 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23198 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23199 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23200 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23201 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23202 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23203 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23204 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23205 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23206 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23207 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23208 and 73, respectively.
23211 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23212 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23213 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23214 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23215 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23216 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23217 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23219 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23220 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23221 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23222 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23223 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23224 delivery to be deferred.
23226 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23227 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23230 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23231 .cindex "envelope sender"
23232 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23233 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23234 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23235 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23236 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23238 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23239 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23240 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23241 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23242 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23243 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23247 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23248 .cindex "carriage return"
23250 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23251 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23252 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23253 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23255 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23256 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23257 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23258 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23259 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23262 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23263 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23264 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23265 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23266 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23267 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23268 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23269 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23270 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23275 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23276 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23277 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23278 .cindex "external local delivery"
23279 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23280 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23281 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23282 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23283 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23284 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23285 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23286 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23287 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23288 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23293 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23297 check_string = "From "
23298 escape_string = ">From "
23307 transport = procmail_pipe
23309 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23310 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23311 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23312 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23313 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23314 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23316 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23320 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23321 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23324 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23325 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23328 local_delivery_cyrus:
23330 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23331 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23343 local_part_suffix = .*
23344 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23346 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23347 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23349 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23350 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23353 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23354 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23356 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23357 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23358 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23359 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23360 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23361 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23362 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23363 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23366 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23367 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23371 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23372 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23373 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23374 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23375 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23376 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23377 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23379 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23380 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23381 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23382 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23383 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23384 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23389 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23390 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23391 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23395 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23397 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23398 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23399 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23400 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23401 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23402 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23403 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23404 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23407 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23408 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23409 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23410 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23411 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23412 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23413 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23414 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23415 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23416 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23417 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23418 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23419 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23420 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23422 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23423 and will be removed in a future release.
23426 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23427 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23428 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23431 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23432 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23433 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23434 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23435 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23436 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23437 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23438 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23440 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23441 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23442 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23443 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23444 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23445 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23446 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23447 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23448 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23451 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23453 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23454 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23455 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23456 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23457 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23460 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23461 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23462 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23463 particular connection.
23465 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23466 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23467 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23468 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23470 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23471 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23472 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23474 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23476 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23477 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23479 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23480 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23484 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23485 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23486 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23487 authenticated as a client.
23490 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23491 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23492 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23493 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23496 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23497 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23498 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23499 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23500 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23501 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23502 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23505 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23506 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23507 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23508 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23509 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23510 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23511 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23515 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23516 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23517 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23518 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23521 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
23522 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23523 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23524 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23525 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23526 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
23527 DKIM signing options. For details see &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23530 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23531 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23532 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23535 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23536 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23537 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23538 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23539 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23540 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23542 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23543 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23544 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23545 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23546 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23547 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23548 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23549 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23553 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23554 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23555 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23556 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23557 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23560 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23561 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23562 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23563 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23567 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23568 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23569 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23570 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23571 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23572 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23573 the dnssec request bit set.
23574 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23578 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23579 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23580 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23581 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23582 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23583 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23584 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23585 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23586 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23590 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23591 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23592 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23593 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23594 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23595 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23596 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23598 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23599 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23600 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23601 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23602 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23605 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23606 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23607 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23608 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23609 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23610 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23611 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23612 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23614 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23615 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23616 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23617 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23618 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23619 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23621 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23622 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23623 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23624 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23625 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23627 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23628 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23629 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23630 copy of the message is sent.
23632 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23633 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23634 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23635 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23639 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23640 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23641 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23644 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23645 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23646 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23647 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23648 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23649 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23651 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23652 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23653 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23654 implementations of TLS.
23656 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23657 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23658 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23659 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23660 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23661 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23662 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23667 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23668 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23669 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23670 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23671 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23672 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23673 interface address, you could use this:
23675 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23676 {$primary_hostname}}
23678 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23681 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23682 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23683 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23684 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23685 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23686 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23688 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23689 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23690 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23691 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23693 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23694 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23695 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23696 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23697 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23698 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23699 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23701 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23702 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23703 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23704 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23705 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23706 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23707 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23710 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23711 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23714 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23715 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23716 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23717 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23718 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23719 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23720 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23721 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23722 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23723 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23726 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23727 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23728 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23729 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23732 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23733 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23734 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23735 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23737 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23738 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23739 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23740 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23741 to any host that matches this list.
23744 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23745 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23746 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23747 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23748 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23749 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23750 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23751 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23754 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23755 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23756 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23761 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23762 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23763 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23764 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23765 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23766 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23767 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23768 explanation of when this might be needed.
23771 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23772 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23773 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23774 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23775 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23778 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23779 .cindex "randomized host list"
23780 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23781 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23782 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23783 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23784 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23785 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23786 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23787 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23789 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23790 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23791 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23792 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23794 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23796 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23797 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23798 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23800 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23801 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23802 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23803 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23804 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23805 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23806 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23807 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23808 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23811 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23812 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23813 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23814 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23815 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23817 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23818 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23819 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23820 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23821 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23823 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23824 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23825 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23826 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23827 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23828 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23830 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23831 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23832 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23833 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23834 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23835 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23836 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23838 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23839 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23840 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23841 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23842 for multi-recipient messages.
23843 The option can usually be left as default.
23845 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23846 .cindex "bind IP address"
23847 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23849 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23850 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23851 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23852 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23853 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23854 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23855 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23856 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23859 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23860 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23861 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23862 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23863 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23864 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23866 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23868 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23869 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23870 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23871 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23874 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23875 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23876 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23877 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23878 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23879 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23880 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23881 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23882 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23883 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23887 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23888 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23889 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23890 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23891 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23893 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23894 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23895 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23896 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23897 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23901 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23902 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23903 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23904 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23905 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23906 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23907 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23908 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23910 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23911 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23912 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23914 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23915 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23916 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23917 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23918 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23919 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23920 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23921 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23923 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23924 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23925 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23926 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23931 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23932 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23933 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23934 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23936 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23937 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23938 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23939 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23940 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23942 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23943 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23944 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23945 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23948 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23949 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23950 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23951 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23952 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23953 addresses is not affected.
23955 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23956 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23957 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23958 Exim to use only the host name.
23959 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23962 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23963 .cindex "serializing connections"
23964 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23965 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23966 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23967 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23968 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23969 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23970 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23972 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23973 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23974 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23975 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23976 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23977 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23979 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23980 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23981 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23982 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23983 are used for ETRN serialization.
23986 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23990 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23991 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23992 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23993 .cindex "size" "of message"
23994 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23995 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23996 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23997 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23998 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23999 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24000 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24001 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24003 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24004 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24008 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24009 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24010 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24011 transport. For details see &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24015 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24016 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24017 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24019 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24020 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24021 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24022 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24023 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24026 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24027 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24028 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24029 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24033 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24034 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24035 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24036 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24037 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24040 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24041 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24042 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24043 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24044 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24045 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24048 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24051 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24052 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24054 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24055 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24056 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24057 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24058 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24059 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24060 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24061 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24064 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24065 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24066 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24068 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24069 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24070 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24071 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24072 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24073 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24074 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24075 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24076 ciphers is a preference order.
24080 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24081 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24082 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24083 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24084 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24085 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24086 certificate and private key for the session.
24088 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24090 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24096 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24097 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24098 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24099 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24100 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24101 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24102 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24103 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24104 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24105 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24109 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24110 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24111 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24112 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24113 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24114 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24115 Note that unless the host is in this list
24116 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24117 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24118 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24119 certificate verification succeeds.
24122 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24123 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24124 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24125 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24126 while verifying the server certificate,
24127 checks will be included on the host name
24128 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24129 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24130 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24132 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24135 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24136 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24137 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24139 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24140 The value of this option must be either the
24142 or the absolute path to
24143 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24144 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24146 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24147 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24148 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24151 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24152 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24154 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24156 either by file or directory
24157 are added to those given by the system default location.
24159 The values of &$host$& and
24160 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24161 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24163 For back-compatibility,
24164 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24165 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24166 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24169 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24170 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24171 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24172 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24173 certificate verification must succeed.
24174 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24175 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24176 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24181 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24183 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24184 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24185 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24186 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24187 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24190 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24191 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24192 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24193 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24196 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24197 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24198 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24200 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24201 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24202 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24203 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24204 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24206 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24207 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24208 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24209 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24210 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24211 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24212 see below for an exception).
24214 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24215 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24216 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24217 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24218 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24220 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24221 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24222 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24223 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24224 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24225 reached their retry times.
24227 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24228 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24229 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24230 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24231 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24232 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24233 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24234 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24235 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24236 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24239 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24240 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24241 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24242 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24243 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24244 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24246 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24247 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24248 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24249 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24250 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24251 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24258 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24260 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24261 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24262 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24263 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24264 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24265 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24267 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24268 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24269 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24270 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24271 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24272 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24273 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24275 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24276 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24277 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24278 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24281 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24282 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24283 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24284 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24286 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24287 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24288 facility; you do not have to use it.
24290 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24291 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24292 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24293 address to which it applies.
24295 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24296 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24297 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24298 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24299 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24300 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24303 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24304 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24305 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24306 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24309 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24310 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24311 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24312 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24313 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24316 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24317 illustrated by these examples:
24320 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24321 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24322 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24323 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24325 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24326 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24331 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24332 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24333 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24334 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24335 message's processing.
24337 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24338 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24339 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24340 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24341 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24342 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24343 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24344 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24345 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24347 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24348 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24349 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24350 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24351 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24352 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24353 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24354 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24355 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24356 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24358 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24359 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24360 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24361 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24362 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24363 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24365 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24366 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24367 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24369 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24370 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24371 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24372 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24373 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24374 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24375 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24376 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24377 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24379 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24380 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24386 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24387 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24388 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24389 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24390 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24391 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24392 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24393 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24394 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24395 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24397 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24399 might produce the output
24401 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24402 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24403 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24404 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24405 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24406 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24407 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24408 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24410 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24411 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24412 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24413 set for a particular transport.
24416 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24417 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24418 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24421 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24423 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24424 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24425 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24426 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24428 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24429 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24430 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24431 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24434 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24435 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24436 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24438 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24439 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24440 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24441 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24442 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24443 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24444 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24446 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24447 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24448 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24449 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24450 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24454 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24455 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24458 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24459 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24460 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24461 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24462 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24463 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24464 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24465 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24466 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24468 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24469 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24470 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24472 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24473 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24474 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24475 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24476 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24477 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24478 of pattern they are set as follows:
24481 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24482 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24483 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24486 *queen@*.fict.example
24488 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24490 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24494 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24495 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24498 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24499 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24500 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24501 rewriting rule of the form
24503 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24505 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24511 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24512 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24513 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24514 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24515 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24519 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24520 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24521 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24522 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24523 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24525 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24527 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24530 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24531 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24532 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24533 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24534 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24535 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24536 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24537 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24538 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24539 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24540 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24541 entry written to the panic log.
24545 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24546 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24549 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24552 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24554 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24557 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24558 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24562 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24564 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24565 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24566 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24567 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24568 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24569 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24571 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24572 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24573 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24574 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24575 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24576 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24577 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24578 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24579 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24580 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24582 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24583 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24584 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24586 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24587 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24590 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24591 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24592 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24593 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24594 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24595 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24596 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24597 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24598 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24600 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24601 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24602 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24603 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24604 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24605 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24606 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24607 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24610 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24611 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24612 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24613 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24616 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24617 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24618 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24620 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24621 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24622 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24623 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24625 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24626 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24627 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24629 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24630 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24631 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24632 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24634 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24638 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24641 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24642 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24643 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24644 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24645 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24646 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24647 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24648 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
24650 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24651 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24655 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24656 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24658 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24659 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24660 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24662 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24663 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24664 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24665 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24666 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24667 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24668 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24669 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24671 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24672 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24674 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24676 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24677 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24679 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24680 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24681 messages that originate outside the local host:
24683 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24684 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24686 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24689 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24690 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24691 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24692 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24693 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24694 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24695 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24696 components. For example, the rule
24698 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24700 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24701 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24702 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24703 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24704 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24705 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24706 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24716 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24717 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24718 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24719 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24720 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24721 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24722 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24723 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24724 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24725 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24726 address, domain and error.
24728 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24729 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24730 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24731 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24732 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24733 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24734 log selector is set, the message
24735 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24736 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24737 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24738 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24740 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24741 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24742 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24743 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24744 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24745 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24746 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24747 domain are maintained independently.
24749 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24750 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24751 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24752 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24753 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24754 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24755 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24756 the local address is reached.
24758 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24759 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24760 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24761 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24762 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24764 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24765 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24766 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24767 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24768 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24769 messages that it should now be retaining.
24773 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24774 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24775 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24776 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24777 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24778 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24779 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24780 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24781 message's sender, respectively.
24784 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24785 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24786 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24787 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24788 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24789 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24792 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24794 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24797 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24799 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24800 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24803 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24804 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24805 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24806 expressions work in address lists.
24808 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24809 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24813 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24814 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24815 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24816 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24817 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24818 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24819 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24820 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24821 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24823 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24824 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24825 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24826 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24829 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24830 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24831 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24832 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24833 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24834 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24835 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24836 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24837 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24838 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24843 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24845 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24846 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24847 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24848 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24849 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24850 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24852 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24856 and the retry rules are
24858 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24859 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24861 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24862 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24863 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24864 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24865 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24866 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24868 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24869 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24870 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24871 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24873 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24874 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24875 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24877 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24879 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24880 textual form of the IP address.
24882 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24883 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24884 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24885 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24888 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24889 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24890 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24892 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24893 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24894 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24896 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24897 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24899 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24900 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24903 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24904 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24905 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24906 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24907 retry rule of this form:
24909 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24911 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24912 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24915 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24916 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24917 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24918 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24921 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24922 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24923 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24924 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24925 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24927 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24928 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24930 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24931 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24934 A connection was refused.
24936 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24937 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24939 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24940 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24942 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24943 A connection attempt timed out.
24945 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24946 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24947 obtained from an MX record.
24949 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24950 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24951 obtained from an MX record.
24954 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24956 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24957 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24958 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24959 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24962 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24965 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24966 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24967 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24968 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24969 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24970 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24974 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24975 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24976 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24977 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24978 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24982 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24983 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24984 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24986 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24987 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24988 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24989 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24990 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24991 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24992 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24994 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24995 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24998 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24999 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25000 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25005 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25006 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25007 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25008 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25009 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25012 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25014 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25016 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25018 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25019 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25022 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25024 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25025 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25026 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25027 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25028 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25030 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25031 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25033 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25035 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25036 list is never matched.
25042 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25043 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25044 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25045 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25047 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25049 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25050 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25051 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25052 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25053 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25055 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25056 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25057 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25058 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25059 The available algorithms are:
25062 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25065 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25066 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25067 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25069 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25070 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25071 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25072 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25073 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25074 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25075 queue processing times.
25078 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25079 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25080 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25081 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25082 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25083 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25084 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25085 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25086 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25087 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25088 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25089 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25091 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25092 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25093 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25094 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25095 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25096 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25099 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25100 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25101 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25102 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25103 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25104 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25105 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25106 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25107 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25108 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25109 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25110 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25112 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25113 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25114 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25115 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25116 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25117 deliveries that have been deferred.
25120 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25121 Here are some example retry rules:
25123 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25124 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25125 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25126 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25127 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25128 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25130 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25131 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25132 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25133 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25134 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25135 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25136 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25139 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25140 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25141 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25142 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25143 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25145 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25146 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25147 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25148 were not obtained from an MX record.
25150 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25151 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25152 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25153 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25154 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25158 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25159 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25160 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25161 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25162 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25163 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25164 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25165 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25166 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25167 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25168 failing for the first time.
25170 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25171 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25172 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25173 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25175 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25176 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25177 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25182 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25183 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25184 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25185 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25186 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25187 default retry rule:
25189 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25191 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25192 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25193 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25195 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25196 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25197 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25198 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25199 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25201 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25202 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25203 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25205 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25206 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25207 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25208 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25209 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25210 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25211 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25212 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25214 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25215 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25216 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25217 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25218 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25221 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25222 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25223 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25224 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25225 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25226 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25227 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25228 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25229 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25232 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25233 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25234 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25235 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25236 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25237 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25238 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25239 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25242 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25243 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25244 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25245 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25246 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25247 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25248 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25249 time out the address.
25251 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25252 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25253 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25254 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25255 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25256 considered immediately.
25257 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25258 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25265 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25266 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25268 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25269 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25270 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25271 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25272 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25273 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25274 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25275 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25276 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25279 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25280 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25283 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25284 the client's EHLO command.
25286 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25287 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25289 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25290 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25291 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25292 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25293 with the AUTH command.
25295 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25297 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25298 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25299 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25302 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25303 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25304 unauthenticated connection.
25307 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25308 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25309 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25310 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25312 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25313 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25314 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25315 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
25316 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25317 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25318 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25319 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25324 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25325 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25326 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25327 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25328 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25329 included by setting
25332 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25335 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25340 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25341 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25342 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25343 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25344 work via a socket interface.
25345 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25346 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25347 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25348 supporting setting a server keytab.
25349 The sixth can be configured to support
25350 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25351 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25352 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25353 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25354 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25356 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25357 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25358 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25359 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25360 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25361 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25362 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25364 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25365 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25366 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25367 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25368 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25369 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25373 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25374 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25376 client_secret = secret2
25378 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25379 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25381 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25382 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25383 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25386 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25387 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25388 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25389 authenticating data.
25391 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25392 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25393 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25394 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25395 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25396 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25397 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25398 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25399 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25400 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25403 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25404 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25405 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25406 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25410 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25411 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25412 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25414 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25415 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25416 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25417 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25418 encrypted by a setting such as:
25420 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25424 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25425 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25426 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25427 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25430 .option driver authenticators string unset
25431 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25432 authenticators is to be used.
25435 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25436 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25437 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25438 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25439 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25440 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25443 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25444 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25445 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25446 mechanism is not advertised.
25447 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25448 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25449 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25452 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25453 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25454 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25457 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25458 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25460 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25461 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25462 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25463 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25464 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25465 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25466 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25467 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25468 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25472 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25473 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25474 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25475 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25476 out the values of variables.
25477 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25478 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25481 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25482 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25483 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25484 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25485 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25486 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25487 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25488 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25489 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25492 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25493 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25494 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25495 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25496 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25497 remembered for later use.
25498 How it is used is described in the following section.
25504 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25505 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25506 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25507 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25508 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25512 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25513 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25515 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25517 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25518 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25519 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25520 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25521 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25522 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25523 given for the MAIL command.
25525 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25526 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25529 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25530 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25531 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25532 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25533 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25534 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25535 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25540 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25541 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25542 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25543 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25545 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25546 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25547 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25548 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25549 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25554 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25555 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25556 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25557 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25561 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25563 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25564 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25567 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25568 the mechanisms are advertised.
25570 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25571 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25572 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25573 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25574 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25575 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25576 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25578 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25580 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25582 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25583 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25584 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25587 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25589 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25590 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25591 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25593 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25594 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25595 command. This is the case if
25598 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25600 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25602 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25603 server authenticators.
25607 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25608 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25609 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25611 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25612 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25613 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25614 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25615 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25616 rejected with a 504 error.
25618 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25619 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25620 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25621 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25622 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25623 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25624 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25625 no successful authentication.
25630 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25631 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25632 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25633 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25634 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25635 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25636 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25640 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25642 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25643 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25644 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25645 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25646 command line to run this script on such data might be
25648 encode '\0user\0password'
25650 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25651 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25652 whose code value is zero.
25654 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25655 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25656 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25657 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25659 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25660 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25661 example, a command such as
25663 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25665 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25667 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25668 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25670 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25672 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25673 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25674 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25675 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25679 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25680 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25681 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25682 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25683 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25684 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25687 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25688 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25689 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25690 of the authenticator.
25693 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25694 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25695 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25696 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25697 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25698 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25699 delivery to be deferred.
25701 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25702 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25703 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25706 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25707 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25708 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25709 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25710 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25711 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25712 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25713 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25714 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25717 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25718 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25719 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25720 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25721 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25722 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25723 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25724 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25725 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25726 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25727 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25728 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25729 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25737 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25739 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25740 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25741 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25742 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25743 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25744 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25745 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25746 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25747 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25748 connections as you do for login accounts.
25750 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25751 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25752 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25754 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25755 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25756 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25758 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25759 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25760 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25763 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25764 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25765 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25766 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25767 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25768 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25769 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25771 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25772 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25773 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25774 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25775 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25776 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25777 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25779 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25780 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25781 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25782 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25784 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25785 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25786 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25788 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25789 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25790 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25791 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25792 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25793 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25794 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25795 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25796 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25797 string as the error text
25799 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25800 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25801 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25805 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25806 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25807 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25808 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25809 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25810 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25811 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25812 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25814 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25815 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25816 configured as follows:
25820 public_name = PLAIN
25822 server_condition = \
25823 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25824 server_set_id = $auth2
25826 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25827 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25828 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25829 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25831 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25832 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25833 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25834 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25838 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25840 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25842 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25843 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25847 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25848 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25850 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25851 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25852 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25853 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25854 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25856 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25857 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25858 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25860 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25861 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25862 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25863 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25864 This is an incorrect example:
25866 server_condition = \
25867 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25869 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25870 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25871 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25872 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25873 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25874 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25875 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25877 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25878 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25880 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25881 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25882 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25883 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25884 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25887 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25888 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25889 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25890 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25891 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25892 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25893 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25897 public_name = LOGIN
25898 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25899 server_condition = \
25900 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25901 server_set_id = $auth1
25903 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25904 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25905 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25906 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25908 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25909 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25910 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25911 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25912 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25916 public_name = LOGIN
25917 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25918 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25921 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25922 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25923 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25924 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25926 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25927 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25928 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25929 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25930 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25931 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25932 uninterpreted string.
25935 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25936 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25937 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25938 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25939 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25945 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25946 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25947 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25949 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25950 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25951 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25952 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25955 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25956 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25957 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25958 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25959 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25960 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25961 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25962 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25963 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25964 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25965 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25966 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25968 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25969 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25971 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25972 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25973 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25974 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25977 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25978 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25982 public_name = PLAIN
25983 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25985 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25986 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25987 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25991 public_name = LOGIN
25992 client_send = : username : mysecret
25994 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25995 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25997 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25998 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26003 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26004 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26006 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26007 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26008 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26009 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26010 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26011 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26012 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26013 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26014 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26015 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26016 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26017 available in plain text at either end.
26020 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26021 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26022 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26023 authenticator as a server:
26025 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26026 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26027 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26028 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26029 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26030 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26031 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26032 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26033 returned to the client.
26035 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26036 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26037 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26038 numeric variables for other things.
26040 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26041 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26042 user name, authentication fails.
26046 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26047 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26048 server_set_id = $auth1
26050 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26051 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26052 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26053 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26057 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26058 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26060 server_set_id = $auth1
26062 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26063 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26065 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26066 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26067 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26072 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26073 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26074 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26075 server_set_id = $auth1
26078 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26079 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26080 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26084 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26085 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26086 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26089 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26090 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26091 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26095 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26096 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26097 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26098 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26099 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26100 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26101 send the message to the current server.
26103 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26108 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26110 client_secret = secret
26112 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26113 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26117 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26118 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26120 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26121 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26122 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26123 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26125 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26126 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26128 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26129 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26130 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26131 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26132 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26134 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26135 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26136 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26137 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26139 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26140 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26141 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26142 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26143 depending on the driver you are using.
26145 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26146 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26147 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26148 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26149 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26152 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26153 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26154 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26155 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26156 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26157 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26158 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26159 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26162 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26163 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26164 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26165 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26166 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26167 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26171 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26172 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26173 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26174 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26177 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26178 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26179 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26180 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26184 driver = cyrus_sasl
26185 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26186 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26187 server_set_id = $auth1
26190 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26191 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26194 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26195 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26198 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26199 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26200 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26201 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26204 driver = cyrus_sasl
26205 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26206 server_set_id = $auth1
26209 driver = cyrus_sasl
26210 public_name = PLAIN
26211 server_set_id = $auth2
26213 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26214 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26215 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26216 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26217 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26222 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26223 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26224 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26225 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26226 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26227 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26228 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26229 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26230 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26231 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26232 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26234 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26236 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26237 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26238 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26239 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26243 public_name = PLAIN
26244 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26245 server_set_id = $auth1
26250 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26251 server_set_id = $auth1
26253 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26254 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26255 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26256 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26257 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26258 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26259 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26260 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26263 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26264 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26265 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26266 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26267 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26268 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26269 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26270 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26271 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26272 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26273 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26274 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26275 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26276 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26277 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26278 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26279 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26280 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26281 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26282 without code changes in Exim.
26285 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26286 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26287 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26288 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26289 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26292 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26293 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26294 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26296 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26297 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26298 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26300 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26301 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26302 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26305 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26306 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26307 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26308 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26311 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26312 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26313 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26314 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26319 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26320 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26321 server_set_id = $auth1
26325 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26326 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26327 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26328 the password itself.
26330 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26331 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26332 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26333 if available, else the empty string.
26334 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26335 else the empty string.
26337 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26339 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26340 option to be simply "true".
26343 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26344 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26345 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26348 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26349 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26350 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26351 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26354 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26355 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26356 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26357 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26360 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26361 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26362 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26365 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26366 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26367 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26368 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26370 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26371 meanings for these variables:
26374 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26375 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26377 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26378 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26380 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26381 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26384 On a per-mechanism basis:
26387 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26388 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26389 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26391 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26392 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26393 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26395 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26396 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26397 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26398 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26401 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26402 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26403 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26406 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26407 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26409 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26411 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26412 server_realm = imap.example.org
26413 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26414 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26415 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26416 server_condition = yes
26420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26423 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26424 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26425 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26426 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26427 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26428 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26429 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26432 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26433 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26434 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26435 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26437 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26438 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26439 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26440 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26442 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26443 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26444 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26448 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26449 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26450 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26451 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26453 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26454 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26455 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26456 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26458 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26460 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26461 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26463 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26464 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26465 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26470 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26473 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26474 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26475 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26476 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26477 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26478 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26479 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26480 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26481 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26482 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26483 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26484 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26485 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26489 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26490 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26492 The server sends back a challenge.
26494 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26495 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26498 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26502 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26503 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26504 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26506 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26507 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26508 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26509 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26510 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26511 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26512 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26513 for other things. For example:
26518 server_password = \
26519 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26521 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26522 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26528 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26529 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26530 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26534 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26535 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26538 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26539 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26542 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26543 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26544 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26550 client_username = msn/msn_username
26551 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26552 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26554 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26555 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26564 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26565 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26566 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26567 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26568 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26569 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26570 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26571 authentication based on client certificates.
26573 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26574 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26575 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26576 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26577 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26578 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26580 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26581 for which it must have been requested via the
26582 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26583 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26585 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26586 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26587 and can authenticate the connection.
26588 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26590 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26593 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26594 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26596 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26597 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26598 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26599 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26600 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26601 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26603 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26604 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26605 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26607 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26614 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26615 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26616 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26618 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26619 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26620 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26622 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26624 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
26625 of your configured trust-anchors
26626 which usually means the full set of public CAs)
26627 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
26628 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
26629 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
26631 . An alternative might use
26633 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
26635 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
26636 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
26637 . This would help for per-device use.
26639 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
26640 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
26642 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26643 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26646 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26647 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26648 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26652 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26653 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26655 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26656 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26657 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26658 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26659 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26662 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26663 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26664 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26665 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26666 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26667 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26668 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26669 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26670 certificates are used.
26672 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26673 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26674 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26675 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26676 between them is encrypted.
26678 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26679 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26680 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26681 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26684 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26685 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26686 in order to get TLS to work.
26690 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26692 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26693 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26694 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26695 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26696 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26697 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26698 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26699 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26700 allocated for this purpose.
26702 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26703 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26704 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26705 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26707 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26709 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26710 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26711 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26712 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26713 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26716 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26717 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26724 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26725 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26726 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26727 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26728 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26732 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26736 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26737 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26739 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26742 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26743 cannot be the path of a directory
26744 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26745 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26747 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26749 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26750 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26751 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26752 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26753 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26755 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26756 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26757 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26758 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26759 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26760 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26761 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26764 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26765 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26767 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26768 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26769 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26770 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26772 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26773 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26774 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26775 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26779 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26780 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26781 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26782 but not the chosen filename.
26783 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26784 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26786 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26787 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26788 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26789 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26791 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26792 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26793 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26794 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26795 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26796 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26797 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26799 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26800 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26801 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26802 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26803 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26805 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26806 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26807 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26808 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26809 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26810 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26812 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26813 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26814 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26816 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26817 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26818 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26819 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26822 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26825 # chown exim:exim new-params
26826 # chmod 0600 new-params
26827 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26828 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26829 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26830 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26831 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26832 # chmod 0400 new-params
26833 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26835 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26836 stalling is removed.
26838 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26839 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26840 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26841 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26842 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26843 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26844 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26845 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26846 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26847 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26848 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26850 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26851 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26852 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26853 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26855 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26856 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26857 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26858 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26859 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26862 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26863 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26864 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26865 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26866 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26867 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26868 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26869 directly to this function call.
26870 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26871 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26872 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26873 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26876 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26878 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26879 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26880 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26883 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26884 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26885 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26889 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26892 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26893 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26896 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26897 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26899 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26900 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26903 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26904 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26905 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26906 not be moved to the end of the list.
26909 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26912 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26913 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26916 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26917 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26918 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26919 choice of clients used:
26921 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26922 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26929 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26931 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26932 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26933 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26934 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26935 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26936 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26937 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26938 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26939 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26940 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26942 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26943 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26945 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26946 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26947 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26948 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26949 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26950 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26952 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26953 "Priority strings". This is online as
26954 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26955 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26956 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26957 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26958 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26962 # Disable older versions of protocols
26963 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26966 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26967 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26968 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26970 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26971 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26972 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26973 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26977 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26983 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26984 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26985 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26986 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26987 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26988 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26989 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26990 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26992 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26993 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26994 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26997 554 Security failure
26999 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27000 rejected with a 554 error code.
27002 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
27003 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
27004 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
27005 without some further configuration at the server end.
27007 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
27008 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
27010 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27011 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27013 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27014 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27015 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27016 that goes with it. These files need to be
27017 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27018 always be given as full path names.
27019 The key must not be password-protected.
27020 They can be the same file if both the
27021 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27022 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27023 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27024 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27025 the server's certificate.
27027 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27028 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27029 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27031 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27032 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27033 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27036 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27037 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27038 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27040 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27042 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27043 with the parameters contained in the file.
27044 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27049 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27050 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27051 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27052 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27058 for a way of generating file data.
27060 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27061 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27062 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27063 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27064 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27066 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27067 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27068 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27069 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27070 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27071 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27072 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27073 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27074 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27076 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27077 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27078 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27079 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27080 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27081 documentation for more details.
27083 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27084 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27087 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27088 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27089 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27090 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27091 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27092 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27093 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27094 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27095 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27096 expected certificates.
27097 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27098 an explicit file or,
27099 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27100 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27102 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27105 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27106 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27107 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27109 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27111 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27113 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27114 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27115 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27116 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27117 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27118 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27119 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27120 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27121 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27122 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27124 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27125 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27126 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27127 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27129 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27130 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27131 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27132 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27133 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27134 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27137 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27138 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27139 .cindex "revocation list"
27140 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27141 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27142 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27143 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27144 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27145 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27146 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27148 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27149 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27151 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27152 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27153 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27154 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27155 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27156 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27158 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27159 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27160 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27161 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27163 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27164 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27165 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27166 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27167 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27168 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27169 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27170 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27172 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27174 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27176 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27178 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27179 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27180 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27181 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27182 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27184 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27185 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27186 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27187 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27188 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27191 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27192 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27195 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27196 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27197 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27198 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27199 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27200 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27202 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27203 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27205 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27208 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27209 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27210 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27212 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27213 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27214 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27220 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27221 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27222 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27223 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27224 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27225 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27226 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27227 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27228 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27230 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27231 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27232 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27233 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27234 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27236 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27237 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27238 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27239 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27240 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27243 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27244 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27245 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27246 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27247 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27248 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27249 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27250 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27251 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27252 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27255 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27256 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27257 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27258 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27260 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27261 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27262 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27264 depending on library version, a directory,
27265 must name a file or,
27266 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
27267 The client verifies the server's certificate
27268 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27269 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27270 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27271 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27273 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27274 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27275 or need not succeed respectively.
27277 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27278 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27279 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27281 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27282 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27283 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27286 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27287 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27288 for OCSP to be relevant.
27291 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27292 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27293 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27294 alternative hosts, if any.
27297 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27298 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27299 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27303 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27304 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27305 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27306 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27307 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27309 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27310 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27311 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27312 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27313 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27314 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27315 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27316 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27317 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27318 outgoing connection.
27322 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27323 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27324 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27325 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27326 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27327 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27328 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27329 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27330 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27331 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27334 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27335 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27338 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27339 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27340 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27341 be of limited use in that environment.
27343 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27344 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27345 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27346 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27347 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27349 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27350 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27351 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27352 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27353 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27355 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27356 received from a client.
27357 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27359 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27360 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27361 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27364 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27365 &%tls_certificate%&
27367 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27370 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27373 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27374 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27376 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27380 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27381 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27382 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27383 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27385 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27388 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27389 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27390 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27391 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27393 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27394 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27395 built, then you have SNI support).
27399 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27401 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27402 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27403 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27404 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27405 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27406 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27407 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27408 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27409 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27410 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27411 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27413 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27414 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27415 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27416 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27417 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27418 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27419 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27420 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27421 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27423 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27424 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27425 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27426 information is recorded.
27428 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27429 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27430 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27435 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27436 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27437 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27438 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27439 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27440 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27441 to Apache, currently at
27443 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27445 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27446 links to further files.
27447 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27448 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27449 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27451 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27455 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27456 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27457 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27458 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27459 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27460 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27461 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27462 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27463 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27464 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27465 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27466 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27467 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27469 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27470 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27471 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27472 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27476 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27477 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27478 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27479 with OpenSSL, like this:
27480 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27481 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27483 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27486 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27487 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27488 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27489 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27490 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27491 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27492 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27494 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27495 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27496 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27497 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27498 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27499 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27501 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27502 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27503 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27504 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27505 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27506 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27507 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27508 be a sensible resolution).
27510 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27511 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27512 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27514 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27515 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27516 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27517 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27518 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27519 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27521 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27522 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27523 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27524 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27525 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27526 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27533 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27534 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27535 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27536 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27537 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27538 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27539 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27540 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27541 one very small ACL:
27545 accept hosts = one.host.only
27547 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27548 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27550 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27551 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27552 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27553 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27554 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27555 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27556 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27557 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27560 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27561 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27562 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27565 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27566 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27567 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27568 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27569 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27570 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27571 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27572 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27573 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27574 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27575 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27576 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27577 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27578 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27579 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27580 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27581 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27582 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27583 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27584 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27587 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27588 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27589 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27590 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27591 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27592 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27593 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27594 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27595 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27596 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27597 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27598 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27599 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27600 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27601 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27602 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27603 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27604 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27605 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27606 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27609 For example, if you set
27611 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27613 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27614 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27615 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27616 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27617 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27618 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27619 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27622 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27623 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27624 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27625 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27626 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27627 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27628 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27629 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27630 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27631 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27632 in any of these ACLs.
27634 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27635 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27636 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27637 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27638 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27639 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27640 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27641 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27643 control = suppress_local_fixups
27645 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27646 run, it is too late.
27648 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27649 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27651 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27652 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27653 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27656 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27657 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27658 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27659 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27660 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27661 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27662 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27663 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27664 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27667 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27668 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27669 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27670 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27671 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27672 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27673 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27674 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27675 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27678 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
27679 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
27680 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
27683 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27684 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27685 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27686 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27690 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27691 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27692 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27693 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27694 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27695 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27696 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27697 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27698 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27699 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27701 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27702 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27703 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27704 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27705 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27706 associated with the DATA command.
27708 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27709 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27710 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27711 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27712 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27715 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27716 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27717 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27718 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27720 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27721 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27722 enabled (which is the default).
27724 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27725 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27726 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27728 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27730 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27733 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27734 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27735 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27737 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27740 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27741 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27742 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27743 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27744 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27745 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27746 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27749 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27750 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27751 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27752 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27753 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27754 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27755 for some or all recipients.
27757 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27758 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27759 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27761 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27762 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27765 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27766 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27767 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27769 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27770 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27772 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27773 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27774 the feature was not requested by the client.
27776 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27777 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27778 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27779 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27780 does not in fact control any access.
27781 For this reason, it may only accept
27782 or warn as its final result.
27784 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27785 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27786 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27787 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27789 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27790 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27792 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27793 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27796 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27797 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27798 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27799 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27800 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27803 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27804 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27805 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27806 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27807 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27808 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27809 situation even worse.
27811 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27812 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27813 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27816 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27817 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27818 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27819 connection. The possible values are:
27821 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27822 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27823 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27824 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27825 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27826 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27827 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27828 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27829 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27830 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27832 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27833 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27834 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27835 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27836 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27840 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27841 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27842 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27843 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27845 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27846 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27848 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27849 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27850 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27851 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27852 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27854 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27855 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27856 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27859 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27860 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27861 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27862 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27863 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27864 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27866 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27867 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27868 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27870 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27871 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27872 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27873 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27875 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27876 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27877 matches the string.
27879 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27880 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27881 want to have something like
27883 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27885 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27886 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27892 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27893 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27894 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27895 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27896 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27897 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27898 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27899 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27900 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27902 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27903 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27904 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27907 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27908 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27909 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27910 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27912 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27913 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27914 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27915 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27916 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27917 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27918 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27921 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27922 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27923 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27927 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27928 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27929 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27930 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27931 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27932 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27934 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27935 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27936 used to accept or reject anything.
27938 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27939 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27940 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27941 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27943 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27944 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27945 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27946 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27947 configuration file.
27952 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27953 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27955 .vindex &$local_part$&
27956 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27957 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27958 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27959 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27960 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27961 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27962 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27963 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27964 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27966 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27967 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27968 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27971 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27972 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27973 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27974 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27975 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27978 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27979 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27980 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27981 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27982 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27983 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27984 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27985 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27991 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27992 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27993 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27994 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27995 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27996 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27997 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27998 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27999 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28000 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28001 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28002 unencrypted connections.
28005 accept encrypted = *
28006 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28008 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28010 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28011 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28012 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28013 option to do this.)
28017 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28018 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28019 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28020 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28021 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28022 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28023 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28025 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28026 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28027 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28030 deny dnslists = list1.example
28031 dnslists = list2.example
28033 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28034 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28035 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28036 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28037 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28040 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28041 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28044 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28045 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28046 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28047 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28048 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28049 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28050 check a RCPT command:
28052 accept domains = +local_domains
28056 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28057 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28058 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28059 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28062 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28063 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28064 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28067 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28068 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28069 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28070 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28071 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28072 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28074 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28075 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28077 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28078 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28079 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28081 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28082 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28083 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28088 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28089 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28090 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28091 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28092 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28093 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28094 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28098 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28099 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28100 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28103 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28105 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28109 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28110 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28111 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28112 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28113 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28114 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28115 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28116 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28117 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28119 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28120 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28121 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28125 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28126 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28127 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28129 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28130 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28132 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28133 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28136 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28137 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28138 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28139 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28141 require message = Sender did not verify
28144 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28145 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28146 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28147 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28150 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28151 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28152 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28153 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28154 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28155 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28156 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28158 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28159 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28160 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28161 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28162 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28164 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28165 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28166 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28167 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28168 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28169 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28173 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28174 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28175 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28176 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28178 warn !verify = sender
28179 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28183 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28185 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28186 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28187 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28188 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28189 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28193 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28194 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28195 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28196 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28197 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28198 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28199 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28200 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28201 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28202 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28204 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28205 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28206 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28207 on the same SMTP connection.
28209 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28210 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28211 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28214 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28215 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28216 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28218 accept hosts = whatever
28219 set acl_m4 = some value
28220 accept authenticated = *
28221 set acl_c_auth = yes
28223 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28224 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28225 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28227 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28228 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28229 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28230 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28231 error is generated.
28233 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28234 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28237 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28238 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28239 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28240 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28242 deny domains = *.dom.example
28243 !verify = recipient
28245 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28246 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28247 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28248 two statements are equivalent:
28250 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28251 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28253 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28254 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28256 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28257 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28258 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28260 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28261 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28262 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28263 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28265 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28266 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28267 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28268 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28269 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28270 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28271 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28273 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28274 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28275 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28276 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28277 message is handled.
28279 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28280 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28281 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28282 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28284 require message = Can't verify sender
28286 message = Can't verify recipient
28288 message = This message cannot be used
28290 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28291 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28292 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28293 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28294 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28295 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28297 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28298 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28299 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28300 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28303 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28304 message = Invalid sender from client host
28306 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28307 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28311 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28312 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28313 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28316 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28317 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28318 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28319 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28321 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28322 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28323 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28324 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28325 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28326 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28327 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28328 write rather ugly lines like this:
28330 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28332 Instead, all you need is
28334 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28337 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28338 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28339 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28340 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28341 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28342 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28343 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28344 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28346 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28347 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28348 in several different ways. For example:
28350 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28351 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28352 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28356 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28358 accept ...some conditions
28359 control = queue_only
28361 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28362 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28365 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28367 accept ...some conditions...
28368 control = queue_only
28369 ...some more conditions...
28371 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28372 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28373 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28377 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28378 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28381 warn ...some conditions...
28385 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28386 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28390 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28391 &%require%& verb. For example:
28393 require control = no_multiline_responses
28397 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28398 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28400 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28401 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28402 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28403 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28404 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28405 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28407 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28410 deny ...some conditions...
28413 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28414 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28417 ...some conditions...
28419 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28420 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28422 warn ...some conditions...
28428 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28429 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28430 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28431 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28432 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28433 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28434 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28438 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28439 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28440 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28441 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28442 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28443 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28444 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28447 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28448 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28449 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28450 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28452 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28453 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28455 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28458 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28459 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28461 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28462 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28463 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28466 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28467 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28468 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28469 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28470 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28471 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28474 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28475 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28476 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28479 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28480 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28481 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28482 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28483 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28484 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28486 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28487 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28488 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28489 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28490 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28491 logging rejections.
28494 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28495 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28496 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28497 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28498 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28499 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28500 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28501 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28503 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28504 &` log_reject_target =`&
28506 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28507 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28511 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28512 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28513 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28514 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28515 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28516 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28517 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28520 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28521 &` control = freeze`&
28522 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28524 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28525 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28526 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28529 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28530 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28534 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28535 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28536 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28537 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28538 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28539 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28540 &%accept%& for details.)
28542 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28543 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28544 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28545 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28546 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28548 require message = Host not recognized
28551 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28554 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28555 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28556 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28557 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28558 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28559 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28560 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28561 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28562 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28565 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28566 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28567 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28569 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28570 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28572 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28573 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28574 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28577 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28578 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28580 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28581 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28582 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28585 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28586 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28587 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28589 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28590 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28591 However, the original message is available in the variable
28592 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28593 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28594 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28595 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28597 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28598 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28599 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28600 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28601 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28602 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28606 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28607 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28608 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28609 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28612 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28613 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28614 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28615 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28618 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28619 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28620 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28621 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28622 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28623 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28624 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28625 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28628 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28629 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28636 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28637 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28638 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28641 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28642 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28643 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28644 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28645 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28646 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28647 not work without it. For example:
28649 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28650 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28652 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28653 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28654 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28655 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28656 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28659 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28660 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28661 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28662 .cindex "case of local parts"
28663 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28664 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28665 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28666 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28667 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28668 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28671 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28672 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28673 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28674 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28675 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28677 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28678 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28681 warn control = caseful_local_part
28682 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28684 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28686 control = caselower_local_part
28688 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28689 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28692 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28693 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28694 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28695 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28697 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28698 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28699 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28700 is used for all recipients of the message,
28701 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28702 and data is copied from one to the other.
28704 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28705 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28706 If a recipient-verify callout
28710 connection is subsequently
28711 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28712 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28713 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28715 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28716 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28717 Note also that headers cannot be
28718 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28719 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28722 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
28723 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
28724 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
28725 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
28729 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28730 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28731 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28732 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28734 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28735 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28736 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28737 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28738 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28739 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28741 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28743 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28746 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28747 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28748 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28749 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28750 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28751 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28752 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28753 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28754 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28758 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28759 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28760 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28764 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28765 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28766 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28767 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28768 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28771 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28772 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28773 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28774 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28775 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28776 strings or to numeric value.
28777 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28778 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28779 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28781 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28782 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28783 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28784 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28785 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28788 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28789 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28790 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28791 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28792 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28793 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28794 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28795 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28797 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28798 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28799 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28800 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28801 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28802 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28806 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28807 .cindex "fake defer"
28808 .cindex "defer, fake"
28809 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28810 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28811 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28812 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28813 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28815 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28816 .cindex "fake rejection"
28817 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28818 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28819 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28820 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28821 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28822 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28823 the same SMTP connection.
28825 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28826 message is supplied, the following is used:
28828 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28829 550-kept for evaluation.
28830 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28831 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28833 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28835 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28836 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28837 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28838 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28839 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28840 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28843 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28844 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28845 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28846 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28848 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28849 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28850 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28851 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28852 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28853 disables such output flushing.
28855 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28856 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28857 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28858 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28859 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28860 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28862 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28863 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28864 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28865 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28866 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28867 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28868 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28869 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28870 to be useful in production.
28872 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28873 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28874 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28875 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28876 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28878 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28879 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28880 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28881 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28882 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28883 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28886 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28887 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28888 verification failed"&) is sent.
28890 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28894 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28895 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28897 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28898 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28899 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28900 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28901 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28902 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28903 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28905 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28906 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28907 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28908 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28909 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28910 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28911 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28912 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28913 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28914 same SMTP connection.
28916 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28917 .cindex "message" "submission"
28918 .cindex "submission mode"
28919 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28920 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28921 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28922 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28923 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28924 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28925 late (the message has already been created).
28927 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28928 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28929 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28930 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28931 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28933 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28934 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28935 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28936 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28937 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28940 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28941 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28943 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28945 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28948 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28949 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28950 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28951 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28954 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28955 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28958 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
28959 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
28961 For details see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
28966 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28967 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28970 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28972 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28973 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28975 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28977 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28982 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28983 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28984 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28985 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28986 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28987 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28989 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28990 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28991 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28993 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28994 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28995 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28996 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28997 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29000 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29001 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
29003 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29004 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29005 contains one or more newlines that
29006 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29007 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29008 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29010 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29011 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29012 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29013 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29014 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29015 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29016 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29017 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29018 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29019 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29020 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29022 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29023 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29025 until they are added to the
29026 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29027 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29028 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29029 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29030 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29031 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29032 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29034 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29036 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29037 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29039 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29040 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29042 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29043 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29045 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29046 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29047 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29048 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29051 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29052 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29053 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29054 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29055 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29056 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29057 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29060 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29061 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29062 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29063 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29064 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29066 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29067 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29068 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29069 to be a header name first.) For example:
29071 warn add_header = \
29072 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29074 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29075 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29076 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29077 up in reverse order.
29079 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29080 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29081 system filter or in a router or transport.
29085 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29086 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29087 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29088 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29089 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29090 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29092 warn message = Remove internal headers
29093 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29095 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29096 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29097 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29098 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29099 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29100 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29102 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
29103 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
29105 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29106 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29107 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29108 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29109 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29111 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29112 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29113 warn message = Remove internal headers
29114 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29116 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29117 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29118 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29119 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29120 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29121 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29122 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29123 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29124 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29125 would have been removed.
29127 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29128 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29129 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29130 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29131 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29132 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29133 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29134 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29135 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29137 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29138 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29140 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29141 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29143 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29144 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29146 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29147 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29148 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29149 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29152 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29153 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29154 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29159 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29160 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29161 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29162 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29163 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29164 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29166 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29167 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29168 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29169 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29170 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29171 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29172 The conditions are as follows:
29176 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29177 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29178 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29179 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29180 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29181 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29182 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29183 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29184 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29185 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29186 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29187 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29189 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29190 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29191 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29192 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29193 The name and values are expanded separately.
29194 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29195 will act as argument separators.
29197 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29198 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29199 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29200 conditions are tested.
29202 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29203 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29204 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29205 for different local users or different local domains.
29207 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29208 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29209 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29210 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29211 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29212 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29213 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29218 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29219 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29220 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29221 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29222 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29223 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29224 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29225 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29226 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29227 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29228 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29229 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29232 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29233 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29234 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29235 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29236 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29237 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29238 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29239 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29241 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
29242 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
29243 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29244 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
29245 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
29247 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29248 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29249 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29250 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29251 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29252 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29253 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29254 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29255 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29256 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29258 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29259 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29260 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29261 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29262 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29263 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29264 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29265 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29266 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29269 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29270 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29273 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29274 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29275 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29276 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29277 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29278 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29279 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29285 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29286 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29287 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29288 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29289 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29290 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29291 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29293 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29295 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29296 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29297 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29299 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29300 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29301 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29302 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29303 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29304 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29306 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29307 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29309 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29310 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29312 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29313 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29314 statement can then check the IP address.
29316 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29317 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29318 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29319 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29321 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29322 message = $host_data
29324 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29326 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29327 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29328 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29329 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29330 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29331 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29332 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29333 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29334 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29335 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29337 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29338 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29339 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29340 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29341 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29342 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29343 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29345 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29346 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29347 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29348 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29349 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29350 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29351 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29354 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29355 .cindex "rate limiting"
29356 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29357 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29359 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29360 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29361 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29362 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29363 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29364 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29366 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29367 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29368 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29369 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29370 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29371 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29372 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29374 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29375 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29376 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29377 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29378 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29379 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29380 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29381 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29382 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29383 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29384 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29385 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29386 influence the sender checking.
29388 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29389 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29391 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29392 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29393 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29394 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29395 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29396 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29400 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29401 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29403 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29404 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29405 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29406 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29407 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29408 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29410 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29411 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29412 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29413 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29414 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29415 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29416 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29417 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29418 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29419 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29421 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29422 .cindex "CSA verification"
29423 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29424 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29425 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29427 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29428 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29429 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29430 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29431 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29432 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29433 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29434 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29435 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29436 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29438 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29439 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29440 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29442 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29443 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29444 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29445 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29446 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29447 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29448 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29449 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29450 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29451 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29452 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29453 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29454 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29455 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29456 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29458 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29459 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29460 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29461 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29464 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29465 !verify = header_sender
29468 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29469 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29470 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29471 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29472 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29473 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29474 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29475 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29476 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29477 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29478 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29479 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29480 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29483 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29484 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29488 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29489 common as they used to be.
29491 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29492 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29493 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29494 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29495 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29496 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29497 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29498 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29499 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29500 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29501 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29502 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29503 independently of this condition.
29505 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29506 option), this condition is always true.
29509 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29510 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29511 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29512 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29513 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29514 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29515 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29516 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29517 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29519 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29520 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29523 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29524 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29525 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29526 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29527 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29528 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29529 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29530 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29531 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29532 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29533 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29534 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29535 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29536 value for the child address.
29538 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29539 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29540 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29541 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29542 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29543 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29544 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29545 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29546 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29547 original IP address.
29549 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29550 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29552 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29553 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29555 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29556 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29557 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29558 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29559 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29560 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29561 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29562 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29563 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29565 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29566 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29567 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29568 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29569 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29570 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29571 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29573 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29574 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29575 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29577 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29578 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29579 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29580 verified as a sender.
29585 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29586 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29587 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29588 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29589 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29590 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29591 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29592 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29593 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29594 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29596 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29597 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29599 the following records are looked up:
29601 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29602 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29604 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29605 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29606 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29607 use two separate conditions:
29609 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29610 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29612 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29613 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29614 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29617 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29618 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29619 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29620 following special items in the list:
29622 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29623 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29624 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29626 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29627 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29628 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29629 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29631 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29633 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29634 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29636 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29637 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29638 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29640 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29642 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29644 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29646 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29647 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29648 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29649 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29653 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29654 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29655 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29656 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29657 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29659 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29661 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29662 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29663 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29664 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29669 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29670 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29671 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29672 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29673 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29674 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29675 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29677 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29678 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29680 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29681 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29682 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29683 up by this example is
29685 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29687 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29688 addresses. For example:
29690 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29691 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29693 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29694 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29699 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29700 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29701 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29702 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29703 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29704 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29705 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29706 either to double the separators like this:
29708 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29710 or to change the separator character, like this:
29712 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29714 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29715 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29716 occurs. Consider this condition:
29718 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29720 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29722 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29723 a.domain.black.list.tld
29725 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29726 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29727 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29728 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29729 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29730 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29731 error for a previous item.
29733 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29734 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29736 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29737 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29739 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29740 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29742 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29743 $sender_address_domain \
29744 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29746 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29747 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29748 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29750 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29751 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29752 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29753 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29755 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29757 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29758 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29760 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29761 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29766 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29767 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29768 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29769 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29770 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29771 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29775 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29777 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29778 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29779 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29781 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29782 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29783 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29786 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29787 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29788 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29789 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29790 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29791 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29792 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29793 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29794 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29795 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29796 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29797 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29798 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29799 cases, for example:
29801 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29803 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29804 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29805 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29806 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29808 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29810 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29811 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29813 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29814 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29815 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29816 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29817 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29820 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29821 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29822 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29824 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29825 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29827 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29832 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29833 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29834 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29835 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29838 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29840 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29841 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29842 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29843 describes how multiple records are handled.
29845 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29846 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29847 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29849 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29851 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29852 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29853 first. For example:
29855 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29856 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29859 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29860 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29861 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29862 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29863 tested. For example:
29865 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29867 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29868 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29869 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29871 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29873 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29878 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29879 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29882 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29884 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29885 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29887 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29889 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29890 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29891 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29892 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29894 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29895 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29897 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29898 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29900 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29901 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29903 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29904 Consider this example:
29906 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29908 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29911 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29913 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29915 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29916 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29917 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29919 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29924 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29925 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29926 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29927 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29928 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29929 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29931 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29933 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29934 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29935 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29936 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29937 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29938 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29941 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29942 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29943 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29945 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29946 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29949 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29951 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29952 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29954 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29956 for the condition to be true.
29959 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29960 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29962 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29963 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29965 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29967 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29968 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29970 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29971 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29973 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29975 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29976 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29978 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29980 for the condition to be false.
29982 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29983 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29988 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29989 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29990 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29991 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29992 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29993 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29994 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29995 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29996 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29999 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30000 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30001 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30002 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30003 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30004 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30005 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30008 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30009 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30011 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30012 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30014 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30015 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30016 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30017 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30018 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30019 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30021 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30022 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30023 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30025 reject dnslists = \
30026 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30027 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30028 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30029 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30031 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30032 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30033 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30037 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30038 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30039 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30040 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30041 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30042 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30044 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30045 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30047 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30048 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30049 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30051 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30053 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30054 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30056 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30057 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30059 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30060 dnslists = some.list.example
30063 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30064 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30065 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30067 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30070 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30071 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30072 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30073 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30074 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30075 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30076 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30077 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30078 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30079 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30081 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30083 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30084 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30086 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30087 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30088 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30091 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30092 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30093 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30094 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30095 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30096 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30097 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30098 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30099 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30101 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30102 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30103 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30104 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30106 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30107 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30108 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30109 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30110 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30111 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30112 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30113 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30114 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30115 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30117 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30118 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30119 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30122 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30123 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30124 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30125 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30126 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30127 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30129 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30130 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30131 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30132 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30133 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30134 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30135 the &%count=%& option.
30138 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30139 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30140 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30141 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30142 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30144 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30145 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30146 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30147 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30149 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30150 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30151 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30152 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30153 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30154 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30155 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30157 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30158 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30159 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30160 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30161 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30162 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30163 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30165 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30166 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30167 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30168 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30171 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30172 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30173 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30174 multiple different commands.
30176 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30177 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30178 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30179 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30180 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30182 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30185 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30186 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30187 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30188 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30189 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30191 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30192 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30194 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30195 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30196 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30197 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30201 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30202 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30203 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30206 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30207 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30208 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30211 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30212 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30213 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30214 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30215 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30216 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30219 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30220 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30221 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30222 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30223 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30226 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30227 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30228 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30229 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30230 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30231 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30234 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30235 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30236 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30237 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30238 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30239 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30240 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30241 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30242 from getting any email through.
30244 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30245 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30246 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30247 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30248 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30249 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30250 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30251 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30253 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30257 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30258 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30259 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30260 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30261 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30262 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30263 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30264 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30265 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30267 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30268 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30269 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30270 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30271 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30272 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30274 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30275 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30278 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30279 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30280 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30281 required increases with larger limits.
30283 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30284 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30285 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30286 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30287 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30288 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30289 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30290 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30291 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30295 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30296 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30297 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30298 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30299 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30300 message. For example:
30302 # Log all senders' rates
30303 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30304 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30306 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30307 # at the decimal point.
30308 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30309 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30310 $sender_rate_limit }s
30312 # Keep authenticated users under control
30313 deny authenticated = *
30314 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30316 # System-wide rate limit
30317 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30318 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30320 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30321 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30322 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30323 messages per $sender_rate_period
30324 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30325 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30326 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30328 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30329 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30330 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30331 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30332 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30333 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30334 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30338 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30339 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30340 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30341 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30342 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30343 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30344 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30345 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30346 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30348 verify = sender/callout
30349 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30351 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30352 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30353 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30354 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30355 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30356 The available options are as follows:
30359 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30360 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30361 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30363 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30364 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30365 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30366 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30368 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30369 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30371 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30372 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30373 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30374 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30377 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30378 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30379 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30380 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30381 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30382 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30385 warn !verify = sender
30386 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30388 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30389 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30390 verification failure.
30392 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30393 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30396 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30397 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30399 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30401 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30402 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30403 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30405 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30407 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30410 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30411 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30416 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30417 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30418 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30419 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30420 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30421 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30422 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30423 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30424 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30425 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30426 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30427 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30430 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30431 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30432 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30433 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30434 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30435 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30437 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30438 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30439 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30440 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30441 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30443 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30444 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30445 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30446 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30447 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30448 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30449 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30450 supplies a host list.
30451 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30453 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30454 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30455 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30456 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30457 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30458 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30459 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30461 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30462 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30463 following SMTP commands are sent:
30465 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30467 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30470 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30473 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30476 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30477 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30478 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30479 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30480 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30481 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30483 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30484 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30485 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30486 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30487 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30489 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30490 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30491 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30492 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30493 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30498 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30499 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30500 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30501 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30503 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30505 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30506 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30507 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30511 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30512 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30513 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30516 verify = sender/callout=5s
30518 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30519 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30520 the &%connect%& parameter.
30523 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30524 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30525 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30526 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30528 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30530 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30532 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30533 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30534 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30535 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30536 updated in this circumstance.
30538 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30539 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30540 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30541 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30542 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30543 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30546 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30547 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30548 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30549 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30550 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30551 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30552 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30553 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30554 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30555 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30557 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30559 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30562 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30563 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30564 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30567 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30569 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30570 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30571 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30572 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30573 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30576 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30577 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30578 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30579 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30581 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30582 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30583 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30584 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30585 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30586 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30587 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30588 made, until the cache record expires.
30590 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30591 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30592 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30595 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30597 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30598 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30600 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30602 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30603 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30604 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30605 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30609 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30610 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30611 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30612 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30613 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30615 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30617 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30618 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30619 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30620 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30621 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30623 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30624 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30625 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30627 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30629 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30630 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30631 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30632 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30633 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30635 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30636 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30638 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30640 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30641 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30642 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30643 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30644 usefulness of callout caching.
30647 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30648 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30649 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30650 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30651 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30652 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30653 these circumstances.
30655 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30656 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30657 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30658 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30659 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30660 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30661 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30663 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30664 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30665 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30666 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30671 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30672 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30673 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30674 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30675 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30676 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30677 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30678 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30679 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30680 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30682 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30683 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30686 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30687 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30688 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30690 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30691 commands up to and including
30695 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30696 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30697 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30698 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30699 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30700 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30701 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30703 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30704 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30705 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30706 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30707 will eventually be noticed.
30709 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30710 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30711 behaviour will be the same.
30715 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30716 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30717 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30718 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30719 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30720 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30723 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30725 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30726 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30727 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30728 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30729 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30730 550 Sender verification failed
30732 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30733 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30734 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30735 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30738 verify = sender/no_details
30741 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30742 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30743 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30744 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30745 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30746 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30747 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30750 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30751 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30752 verification also fails.
30754 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30755 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30758 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30759 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30760 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30763 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30765 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30766 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30767 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30768 verification to succeed.
30770 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30771 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30772 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30773 option. For example:
30775 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30777 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30778 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30780 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30781 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30782 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30783 address and a report is output for each of them.
30787 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30788 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30789 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30790 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30791 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30792 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30793 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30797 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30798 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30799 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30800 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30801 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30802 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30804 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30805 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30806 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30807 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30810 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30812 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30814 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30815 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30817 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30818 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30821 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30822 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30824 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30826 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30827 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30828 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30829 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30832 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30834 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30835 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30836 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30838 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30839 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30840 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30841 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30842 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30843 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30844 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30845 of legitimate HELO domains.
30847 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30848 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30849 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30850 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30853 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30855 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30856 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30857 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30862 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30863 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30864 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30865 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30866 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30867 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30868 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30869 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30871 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30872 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30873 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30874 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30875 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30876 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30877 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30879 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30880 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30883 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30884 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30887 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30888 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30891 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30892 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30894 recipients = +batv_senders
30896 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30897 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30899 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30900 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30901 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30903 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30904 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30905 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30906 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30907 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30909 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30910 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30911 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30912 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30913 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30914 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30915 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30917 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30918 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30919 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30920 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30924 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30926 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30927 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30928 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30931 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30934 external_smtp_batv:
30936 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30937 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30938 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30939 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30942 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30946 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30947 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30948 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30949 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30950 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30951 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30952 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30953 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30954 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30955 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30957 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30958 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30959 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30960 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30961 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30962 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30964 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30966 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30967 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30968 system to arbitrary domains.
30971 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30972 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30973 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30974 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30977 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30978 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30979 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30981 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30982 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30984 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30985 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30989 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30991 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30992 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30993 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30995 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30999 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31000 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31002 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31003 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31004 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31005 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31006 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31007 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31008 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31012 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31013 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31014 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31015 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31016 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31021 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31022 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31024 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31025 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31026 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31027 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31028 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31029 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31032 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31033 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31034 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31035 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31036 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31038 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31039 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31040 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31043 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31044 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31046 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31047 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31048 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31050 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31051 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31053 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31056 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31059 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
31060 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
31061 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
31063 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31064 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31065 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31066 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31067 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31068 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31070 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31071 temporarily created in a file called:
31073 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31075 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31076 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31077 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31078 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31079 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31081 control = no_mbox_unspool
31083 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31084 same directory by default.
31088 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31089 .cindex "virus scanning"
31090 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31091 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31092 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31093 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31094 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31095 in memory and thus are much faster.
31097 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31098 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31100 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31101 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31102 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31103 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31105 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31107 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31109 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31111 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31113 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31114 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
31118 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31119 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31120 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
31121 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31122 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31123 This scanner type takes one option,
31124 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31125 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31126 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31127 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31128 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31129 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31132 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31133 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31135 If you omit the argument, the default path
31136 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31138 If you use a remote host,
31139 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31140 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31141 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31143 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31150 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31151 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31152 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31153 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31154 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31157 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31162 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31163 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31164 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31165 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31166 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31168 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31169 a UNIX socket specification,
31170 a TCP socket specification,
31171 or a (global) option.
31173 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31174 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31175 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31176 and the second a port number,
31177 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31178 These per-server options are supported:
31180 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31183 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31184 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31186 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31190 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31191 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31192 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31193 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31194 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31196 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31198 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31199 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31200 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31201 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31202 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
31203 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
31205 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31206 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31207 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31208 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31209 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31210 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31211 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31212 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31213 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31215 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31216 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31217 (Connection refused)
31220 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31221 contributing the code for this scanner.
31224 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31225 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31226 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31227 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31230 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31231 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31234 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31235 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31236 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31237 the &"trigger"& expression.
31240 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31241 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31242 &"name"& expression.
31245 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31247 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31249 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31250 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31251 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31252 configuration setting:
31254 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31255 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31256 found in file:'(.+)'
31259 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31260 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31262 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31263 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31264 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31265 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31268 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31269 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31271 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31272 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31275 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31276 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31277 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31281 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31283 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31286 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31287 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31288 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31290 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31292 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31293 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31295 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31296 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31297 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31298 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31299 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31302 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31304 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31307 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31308 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31309 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31310 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31311 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31312 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
31313 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31315 av_scanner = mksd:2
31317 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31320 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31321 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31322 running on the local machine.
31323 There are four options:
31324 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31325 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31326 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31327 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31328 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31331 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31333 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31334 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31335 Both regular-expressions are required.
31338 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31339 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31340 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31341 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31342 client communication. For example:
31344 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31346 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31350 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31351 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31354 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31355 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31356 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31357 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31358 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31359 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31362 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31363 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31364 The first element can then be one of
31367 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31368 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31371 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31372 the condition fails immediately.
31374 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31375 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31376 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31377 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31378 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31381 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31382 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31383 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31385 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31386 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31389 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31391 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31393 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31394 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31395 is set to record the actual address used.
31397 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31398 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31399 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31400 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31403 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31404 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31405 &%malware%& condition.
31407 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31408 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31410 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31412 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31416 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31418 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31420 malware = */defer_ok
31422 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31423 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31425 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31427 in the main Exim configuration.
31429 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31430 set acl_m0 = sophie
31433 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31434 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31439 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31440 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31441 .cindex "spam scanning"
31442 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31444 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31445 score and a report for the message.
31446 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31448 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31449 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31450 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31452 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31454 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31456 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31457 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31460 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31461 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31462 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31463 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31464 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31465 configuration as follows (example):
31467 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31470 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31472 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31474 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31477 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31478 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31479 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31481 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31483 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31484 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31485 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31486 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31488 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31489 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31492 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31493 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31494 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31497 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31498 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31499 and changeable in the usual way.
31501 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31502 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31503 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31504 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31506 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31508 The supported options are:
31510 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31511 weight=<value> Selection bias
31512 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31513 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31514 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31515 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31518 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31519 higher values being tried first.
31520 The default priority is 1.
31522 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31523 Within a priority set
31524 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31525 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31527 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31528 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31529 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31530 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31532 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31533 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31535 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31536 The default value is two minutes.
31538 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31539 a failed connect is made.
31540 The default is to not retry.
31542 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31543 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31544 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31547 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31548 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31549 is set to record the actual address used.
31551 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31552 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31554 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31557 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31558 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31559 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31560 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31561 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31564 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31565 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31566 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31567 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31568 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31570 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31571 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31573 or the use of PRDR,
31574 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31575 are needed to use this feature.
31577 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31578 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31579 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31582 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31583 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31584 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31587 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31588 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31592 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31593 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31594 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31595 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31597 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31598 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31600 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31601 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31602 available for use at delivery time.
31605 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31606 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31607 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31609 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31610 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31611 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31612 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31613 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31615 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31616 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31617 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31618 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31619 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31620 spam bar is 50 characters.
31622 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31623 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31624 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31625 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31627 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31628 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31629 spam score versus threshold.
31630 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31634 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31635 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31636 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31638 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31639 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31640 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31641 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31642 spam condition, like this:
31644 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31645 spam = joe/defer_ok
31647 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31649 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31652 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31653 warn spam = nobody:true
31654 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31655 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31657 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31658 # is over threshold
31660 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31662 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31663 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31665 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31670 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31671 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31672 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31673 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31674 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31675 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31676 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31677 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31678 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31679 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31682 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31683 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31684 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31685 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31686 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31687 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31688 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31690 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31691 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31692 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31693 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31694 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31696 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31697 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31698 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31699 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31700 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31703 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31705 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31709 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31711 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31712 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31713 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31714 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31716 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31717 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31718 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31719 the full path and file name.
31721 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31722 filename, and the default path is then used.
31724 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31725 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31726 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31728 decode = $mime_filename
31730 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31731 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31732 automatically unlinked.
31734 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31735 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31736 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31737 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31738 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31740 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31741 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31742 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31744 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31745 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31746 available in the MIME ACL:
31749 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31750 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31751 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31752 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31753 contains the empty string.
31755 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31756 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31757 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31763 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31764 case-insensitively.
31766 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31767 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31768 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31769 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31770 only used for display purposes.
31772 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31773 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31774 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31776 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31777 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31778 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31780 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31781 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31782 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31783 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31784 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31786 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31787 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31788 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31789 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31791 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31792 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31793 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31794 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31798 application/octet-stream
31802 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31805 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31806 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31807 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31808 containing the decoded data.
31813 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31814 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31815 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31816 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31819 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31821 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31823 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31824 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31825 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31826 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31828 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31829 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31833 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31836 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31837 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31840 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31841 and the rest are attachments.
31844 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31847 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31848 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31849 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31851 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31852 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31853 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31854 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31856 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31857 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31858 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31859 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31860 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31862 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31863 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31864 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31865 decoding is fully recursive.
31867 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31868 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31869 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31870 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31871 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31872 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31873 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31878 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31879 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31880 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31881 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31882 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31884 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31885 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31886 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31887 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31888 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31890 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31891 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31892 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31893 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31894 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31895 32K characters are checked.
31897 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31898 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31899 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31900 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31901 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31903 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31904 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31906 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31907 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31908 matching regular expression.
31909 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31910 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31912 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31918 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31919 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31920 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31921 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31922 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31923 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31924 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31925 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31926 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31927 use the &%demime%& condition.
31929 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31930 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31931 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31932 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31933 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31934 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31936 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31937 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31940 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31941 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31943 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31944 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31945 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31946 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31948 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31949 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31950 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31952 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31955 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31956 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31957 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31958 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31959 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31960 zero, no error occurred.
31962 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31963 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31964 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31965 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31969 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31970 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31971 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31972 extension it found.
31975 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31976 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31978 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31979 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31980 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31983 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31984 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31986 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31988 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31989 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31990 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31991 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31993 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31994 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31995 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
32004 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32005 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32007 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32008 "Local scan function"
32009 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32010 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32011 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32012 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32013 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32015 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32016 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32017 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32018 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32019 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32021 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32022 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32023 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32024 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32026 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32027 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32028 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32029 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32031 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32032 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32033 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32034 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32035 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32036 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32037 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32038 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32039 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32043 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32044 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32045 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32046 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32047 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32048 directory, so you might set
32050 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32052 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32053 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32054 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32055 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32056 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32057 _src/local_scan.c_.
32059 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32060 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32062 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32064 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32069 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32070 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32071 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32073 #include "local_scan.h"
32075 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32076 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32077 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32078 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32079 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32080 strings and pointers to character strings:
32082 #define CS (char *)
32083 #define CCS (const char *)
32084 #define CSS (char **)
32085 #define US (unsigned char *)
32086 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32087 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32089 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32091 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32093 The arguments are as follows:
32096 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32097 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32098 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32100 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32101 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32102 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32103 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32104 case this changes in some future version.
32106 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32107 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32110 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32113 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32114 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32115 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32116 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32117 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32118 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32120 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32121 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32122 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32124 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32125 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32126 queued without immediate delivery.
32128 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32129 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32130 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32131 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32132 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32135 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32136 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32137 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32140 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32141 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32142 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32143 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32144 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32145 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32146 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32148 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32149 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32150 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32153 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32154 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32155 &%-oe%& command line options.
32159 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32160 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32161 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32162 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32163 want to do this, you must have the line
32165 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32167 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32168 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32169 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32172 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32173 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32174 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32175 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32176 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32177 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32179 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32180 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32182 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32183 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32184 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32187 int local_scan_options_count =
32188 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32190 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32191 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32195 my_string = some string of text...
32197 The available types of option data are as follows:
32200 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32201 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32202 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32203 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32204 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32205 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32208 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32209 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32210 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32211 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32214 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32215 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32218 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32219 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32220 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32221 printed with the suffix K or M.
32223 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32224 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32225 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32226 always output in octal.
32228 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32229 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32230 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32232 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32233 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32234 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32237 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32238 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32242 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32243 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32244 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32245 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32246 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32247 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32248 C variables are as follows:
32251 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32252 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32254 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32255 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32257 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32258 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32259 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32260 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32263 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32264 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32265 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32268 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32269 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32273 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32274 selected, you should use code like this:
32276 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32277 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32279 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32280 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32281 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32283 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32284 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32287 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32288 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32290 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32291 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32293 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32294 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32295 &%-bh%& command line option.
32297 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32298 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32299 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32301 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32302 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32303 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32304 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32306 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32307 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32308 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32310 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32311 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32313 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32314 The number of accepted recipients.
32316 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32317 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32318 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32319 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32320 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32321 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32322 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32323 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32324 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32325 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32326 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32327 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32329 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32330 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32332 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32333 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32334 locally-submitted messages.
32336 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32337 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32338 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32340 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32341 The name of the sending host, if known.
32343 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32344 The port on the sending host.
32346 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32347 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32349 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32350 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32352 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32353 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32354 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32358 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32359 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32360 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32361 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32366 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32367 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32369 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32370 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32371 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32372 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32373 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32374 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32375 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32377 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32378 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32381 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32382 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32383 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32388 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32389 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32392 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32393 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32395 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32396 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32397 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32398 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32400 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32401 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32402 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32403 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32404 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32405 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32406 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32407 is NULL for all recipients.
32412 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32413 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32414 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32415 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32419 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32420 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32422 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32423 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32424 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32425 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32427 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32428 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32429 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32430 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32431 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32433 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32435 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32436 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32437 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32438 return value is as follows:
32443 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32449 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32455 The process timed out.
32459 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32462 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32463 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32464 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32465 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32466 forks a subprocess that is running
32468 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32470 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32471 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32472 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32473 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32475 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32476 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32477 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32478 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32481 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32482 *sender_authentication)*&
32483 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32486 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32488 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32491 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32492 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32493 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32494 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32495 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32497 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32498 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32501 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32502 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32503 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32504 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32505 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32506 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32507 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32508 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32510 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32511 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32512 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32513 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32514 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32515 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32517 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32518 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32519 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32520 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32522 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32523 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32524 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32525 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32526 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32527 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32528 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32529 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32530 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32531 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32533 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32534 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32536 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32537 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32540 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32541 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32542 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32543 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32544 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32547 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32548 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32549 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32550 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32551 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32552 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32554 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32556 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32557 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32558 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32559 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32560 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32563 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32564 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32565 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32566 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32567 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32568 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32569 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32570 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32572 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32573 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32574 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32576 &`OK `& match succeeded
32577 &`FAIL `& match failed
32578 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32580 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32581 inability to contact a database.
32583 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32585 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32586 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32587 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32589 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32591 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32592 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32593 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32595 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32597 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32600 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32602 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32603 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32604 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32605 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32606 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32607 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32610 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32612 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32613 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32614 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32615 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32616 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32617 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32620 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32621 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32622 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32623 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32625 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32626 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32627 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32628 value afterwards. For example:
32630 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32631 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32632 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32635 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32636 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32637 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32638 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32645 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32646 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32647 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32648 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32649 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32650 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32651 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32652 binary string is returned with an error message.
32654 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32655 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32656 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32658 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32659 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32660 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32661 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32662 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32664 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32665 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32666 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32668 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32669 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32670 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32671 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32675 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32676 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32679 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32680 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32681 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32682 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32683 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32684 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32685 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32686 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32689 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32690 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32692 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32693 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32694 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32695 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32696 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32697 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32698 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32700 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32701 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32703 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32704 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32705 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32706 multiple output lines.
32708 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32709 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32710 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32711 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32712 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32713 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32714 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32717 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32718 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32719 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32720 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32722 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32723 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32724 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32726 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32729 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32732 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32733 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32734 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32735 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32736 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32737 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32743 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32744 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32745 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32746 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32747 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32748 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32749 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32752 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32753 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32754 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32755 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32757 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32758 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32760 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32762 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32763 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32764 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32765 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32767 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32768 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32769 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32770 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32778 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32780 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32781 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32782 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32783 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32784 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32785 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32786 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32787 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32789 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32790 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32791 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32792 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32793 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32795 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32796 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32797 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32798 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32799 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32800 prevent it happening on retries.
32802 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32803 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32804 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32805 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32806 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32807 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32808 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32809 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32812 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32813 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32814 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32815 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32816 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32817 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32818 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32820 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32821 system_filter_user = exim
32823 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32824 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32825 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32826 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32827 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32828 by the &%reply%& command.
32831 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32832 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32833 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32834 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32836 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32837 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32841 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32842 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32843 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32844 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32845 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32846 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32849 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32850 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32851 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32852 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32853 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32854 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32855 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32857 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32858 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32859 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32860 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32861 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32863 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32864 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32865 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32866 to which users' filter files can refer.
32870 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32871 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32872 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32873 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32874 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32878 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32879 .cindex "freezing messages"
32880 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32881 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32882 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32883 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32884 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32885 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32886 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32887 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32888 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32889 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32891 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32893 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32895 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32896 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32897 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32898 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32899 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32902 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32903 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32904 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32905 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32907 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32908 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32909 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32910 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32911 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32912 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32913 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32914 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32915 message. For example:
32917 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32918 because it contains attachments that we are \
32919 not prepared to receive."
32922 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32923 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32924 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32925 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32926 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32927 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32930 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32931 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32933 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32934 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32935 generated by the filter.
32937 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32939 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32940 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32946 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32947 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32952 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32953 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32954 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32955 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32956 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32958 headers add <string>
32959 headers remove <string>
32961 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32962 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32963 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32964 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32965 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32967 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32968 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32969 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32972 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32973 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32976 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32977 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32978 space after input continuations is ignored.
32980 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32981 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32982 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32983 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32984 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32986 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32987 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32988 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32989 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32990 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32991 used for all recipients of the message.
32993 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32994 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32995 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32996 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32997 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32998 until the message is actually being written (see section
32999 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33001 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33002 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33003 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33004 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33005 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33006 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33007 modified more than once.
33009 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33010 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33013 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33014 headers remove "Subject"
33015 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33016 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33021 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33022 .cindex "envelope sender"
33023 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33025 errors_to <some address>
33027 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33028 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33029 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33032 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33034 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33035 address if its delivery failed.
33039 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33040 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33041 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33042 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33043 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33044 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33045 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33046 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33047 which implements such a filter:
33052 domains = +local_domains
33053 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33058 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33059 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33060 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33061 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33063 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33064 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33065 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33066 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33068 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33069 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33070 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33077 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33078 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33080 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33081 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33082 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33083 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33084 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33085 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33086 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33087 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33089 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33090 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33091 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33092 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33093 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33095 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33096 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33097 loopback interface specially in any way.
33099 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33100 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33105 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33106 .cindex "message" "submission"
33107 .cindex "submission mode"
33108 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33109 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33110 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33111 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33113 control = submission
33115 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33116 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33117 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33118 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33119 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33120 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33122 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33123 control = submission
33125 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33126 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33127 is used to separate options. For example:
33129 control = submission/sender_retain
33131 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33132 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33133 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33134 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33135 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33136 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33137 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33139 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33140 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33143 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33145 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33146 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33147 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33148 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33150 accept authenticated = *
33151 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33152 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33153 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33155 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33156 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33157 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33159 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33161 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33164 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33166 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33167 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33168 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33169 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33171 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33172 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33173 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33174 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33175 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33176 spoof another's address.
33178 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33179 .cindex "line endings"
33180 .cindex "carriage return"
33182 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33183 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33184 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33185 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33186 use CRLF or just CR.
33188 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33189 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33190 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33191 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33192 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33193 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33194 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33195 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33199 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33201 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33204 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33205 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33208 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33209 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33210 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33211 people trying to play silly games.
33213 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33214 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33222 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33223 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33224 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33225 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33226 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33227 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33228 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33229 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33231 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33232 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33233 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33234 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33235 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33237 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33238 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33239 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33240 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33241 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33242 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33243 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33244 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33249 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33250 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33251 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33252 .cindex "sender" "address"
33253 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33254 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33255 .cindex "envelope sender"
33256 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33257 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33258 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33259 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33261 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33262 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33264 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33265 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33266 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33267 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33268 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33269 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33270 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33271 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33272 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33274 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33275 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33276 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33277 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33278 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33279 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33280 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33282 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33283 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33284 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33286 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33287 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33288 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33289 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33293 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33294 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33295 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33296 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33297 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33298 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33299 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33302 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33303 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33306 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33307 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33311 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33312 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33314 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33315 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33316 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33318 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33321 For a locally-submitted message,
33322 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33323 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33324 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33325 included in log lines in this case.
33327 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33328 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33334 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33335 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33336 includes the header line:
33338 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33341 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33342 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33343 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33344 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33345 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33346 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33349 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33350 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33351 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33352 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33353 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33355 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33356 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33357 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33358 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33359 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33360 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33361 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33362 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33366 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33367 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33368 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33369 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33370 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33371 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33372 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33373 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33377 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33378 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33379 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33380 .cindex "message" "submission"
33381 .cindex "submission mode"
33382 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33383 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33386 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33387 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33389 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33390 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33392 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33393 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33394 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33396 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33397 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33399 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33400 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33404 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33406 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33407 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33408 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33409 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33410 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33411 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33412 &%qualify_domain%&.
33414 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33415 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33416 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33417 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33420 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33421 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33422 .cindex "message" "submission"
33423 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33424 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33425 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33426 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33427 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33428 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33429 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33430 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33431 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33432 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33435 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33436 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33437 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33438 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33439 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33441 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33442 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33443 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33444 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33446 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33447 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33448 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33451 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33452 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33453 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33454 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33455 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33456 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33457 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33458 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33459 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33460 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33461 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33465 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33466 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33467 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33468 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33469 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33470 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33471 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33472 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33476 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33477 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33478 .cindex "message" "submission"
33479 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33480 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33481 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33482 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33485 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33486 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33487 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33488 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33489 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33490 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33491 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33492 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33493 line is added to the message.
33495 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33496 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33497 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33498 options true at the same time.
33500 .cindex "submission mode"
33501 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33502 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33503 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33504 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33506 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33507 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33508 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33509 created as follows:
33512 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33513 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33514 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33516 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33517 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33519 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33520 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33523 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33524 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33525 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33526 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33528 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33529 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33530 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33531 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33535 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33536 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33537 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33538 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33539 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33540 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33541 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33542 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33543 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33545 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33546 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33547 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33548 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33549 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33550 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33552 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33553 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33554 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33556 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33557 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33558 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33560 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33561 X-added-second: another added header line
33563 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33565 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33566 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33567 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33569 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33570 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33571 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33572 not part of the names. For example:
33574 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33577 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33578 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33579 Each item is separately expanded.
33580 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33581 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33582 will act as list separators.
33584 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33585 items are expanded at routing time,
33586 and then associated with all addresses that are
33587 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33588 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33589 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33591 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33592 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33593 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33594 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33596 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33597 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33598 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33601 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33602 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33603 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33604 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33605 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33606 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33607 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33609 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33610 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33611 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33612 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33614 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33615 the following consequences:
33618 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33619 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33620 to it, at all times.
33622 Header lines that are added by a router's
33623 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33624 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33626 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33627 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33629 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33630 a later router or by a transport.
33632 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33633 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33635 headers_remove = subject
33636 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33640 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33641 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33647 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33648 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33649 .cindex "constructed address"
33650 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33653 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33657 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33659 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33660 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33661 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33662 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33663 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33664 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33665 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33666 there is no password file entry.
33669 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33670 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33671 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33672 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33673 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33674 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33675 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33676 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33680 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33681 .cindex "case of local parts"
33682 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33683 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33684 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33685 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33686 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33687 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33688 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33691 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33692 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33693 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33694 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33695 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33699 domains = +local_domains
33700 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33701 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33704 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33705 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33706 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33707 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33708 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33712 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33713 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33714 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33715 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33716 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33717 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33718 empty components for compatibility.
33722 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33723 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33724 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33725 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33726 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33727 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33729 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33730 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33731 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33732 example, a header such as
33736 might get rewritten as
33738 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33740 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33741 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33744 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33745 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33746 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33747 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33748 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33749 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33750 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33754 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33757 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33758 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33759 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33760 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33761 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33762 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33763 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33766 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33768 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33770 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33773 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33776 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33778 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33781 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33784 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33785 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33788 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33789 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33790 used to contain the envelope information.
33794 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33795 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33796 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33797 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33798 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33801 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33802 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33803 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33804 processing is the same in both cases.
33806 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33807 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33808 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33809 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33810 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33811 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33812 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33813 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33816 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33817 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33818 required for the transaction.
33820 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33821 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33822 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33823 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33824 is called for verification.
33826 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33827 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33828 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33830 .cindex "carriage return"
33832 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33833 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33834 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33837 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33838 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33839 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33840 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33841 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33842 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33843 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33844 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33845 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33847 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33848 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33849 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33850 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33852 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33853 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33854 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33855 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33857 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33858 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33859 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33860 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33861 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33862 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33863 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33864 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33865 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33866 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33868 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33869 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33871 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33872 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33873 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33874 square bracket of the IP address.
33879 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33880 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33881 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33882 .cindex "host" "error"
33883 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33884 message errors, and recipient errors.
33887 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33888 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33889 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33892 Connection refused or timed out,
33894 Any error response code on connection,
33896 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33898 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33900 I/O errors at any time,
33902 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33903 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33906 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33907 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33908 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33909 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33910 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33911 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33912 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33913 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33915 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33916 .cindex "message" "error"
33917 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33918 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33919 message errors are:
33922 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33925 Timeout after MAIL,
33927 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33928 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33929 connection at any other time.
33932 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33933 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33934 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33935 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33936 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33937 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33938 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33939 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33940 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33941 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33943 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33944 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33945 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33948 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33949 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33950 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33951 recipient errors are:
33954 Any error response to RCPT,
33956 Timeout after RCPT.
33959 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33960 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33961 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33962 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33963 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33964 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33965 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33966 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33967 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33968 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33969 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33970 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33971 the retry clock is reset.
33973 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33974 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33975 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33976 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33977 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33978 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33979 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33980 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33981 recipient's retry time.
33984 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33985 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33986 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33987 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33988 until the next delivery attempt.
33990 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33991 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33992 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33993 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33994 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33997 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33998 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33999 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34000 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34001 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34002 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34003 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34005 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34006 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34007 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34008 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34009 then to be treated as a host error.
34011 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34012 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34013 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34014 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34015 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34020 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34021 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34022 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34025 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34026 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34027 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34029 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34031 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34032 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34033 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34034 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34035 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34036 stream and exits with an error code.
34038 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34039 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34040 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34041 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34043 .cindex "carriage return"
34045 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34046 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34047 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34049 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34050 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34051 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34053 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34054 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34055 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34056 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34057 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34058 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34059 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34060 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34062 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34063 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34064 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34065 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34066 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34067 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34068 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34069 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34070 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34072 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34073 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34074 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34076 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34077 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34078 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34079 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34080 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34082 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34083 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34084 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34085 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34086 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34087 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34088 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34090 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34091 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34092 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34093 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34094 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34096 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34097 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34098 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34099 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34100 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34101 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34102 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34103 a delivery process.
34105 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34106 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34107 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34108 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34109 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34111 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34112 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34113 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34114 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34116 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34117 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34118 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34122 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34123 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34124 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34125 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34126 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34127 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34128 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34129 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34132 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34133 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34134 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34135 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34136 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34137 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34138 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34139 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34140 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34141 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34142 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34146 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34147 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34148 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34149 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34150 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34151 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34152 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34153 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34155 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34156 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34157 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34158 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34159 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34162 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34163 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34164 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34166 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34167 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34168 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34169 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34170 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34175 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34176 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34177 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34178 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34181 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34182 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34183 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34184 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34185 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34187 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34188 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34189 SMTP response codes.
34191 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34192 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34193 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34194 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34195 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34196 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34197 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34198 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34203 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34204 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34205 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34206 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34207 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34208 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34209 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34211 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34212 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34213 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34214 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34215 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34216 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34217 argument. For example,
34225 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34226 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34227 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34228 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34229 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34231 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34232 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34233 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34234 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34235 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34236 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34237 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34238 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34240 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34241 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34242 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34243 whatever the form of its argument. For
34246 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34247 $sender_host_address
34249 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34250 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34251 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34252 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34253 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34254 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34255 for it to change them before running the command.
34259 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34260 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34261 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34262 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34263 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34264 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34265 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34266 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34267 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34268 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34269 runs for RCPT commands:
34273 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34277 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34278 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34279 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34280 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34281 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34282 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34283 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34284 envelope along with the message.
34286 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34287 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34288 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34289 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34290 can be used to specify it.
34292 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34293 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34294 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34295 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34296 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34299 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34300 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34301 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34306 driver = manualroute
34307 transport = smtp_appendfile
34308 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34312 driver = appendfile
34313 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34318 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34319 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34320 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34324 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34325 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34326 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34327 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34328 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34329 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34330 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34331 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34332 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34333 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34335 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34336 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34338 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34339 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34340 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34341 make some use of automatically, for example:
34343 554 Unexpected end of file
34344 Transaction started in line 10
34345 Error detected in line 14
34347 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34350 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34351 The error message was:
34353 501 '>' missing at end of address
34355 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34356 The error was detected in line 12.
34357 The SMTP command at fault was:
34359 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34361 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34362 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34364 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34365 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34367 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34368 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34372 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34373 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34375 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34376 "Customizing messages"
34377 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34378 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34379 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34380 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34381 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34383 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34384 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34385 option. Exim also adds the line
34387 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34389 to all warning and bounce messages,
34392 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34393 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34394 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34395 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34396 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34397 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34398 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34400 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34401 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34402 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34403 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34404 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34407 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34408 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34409 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34410 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34411 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34412 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34413 option, rounded to a whole number.
34415 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34418 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34419 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34421 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34422 failing addresses with their error messages.
34424 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34425 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34427 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34428 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34431 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34432 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34433 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34435 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34436 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34437 {: returning message to sender}}
34439 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34441 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34442 {that you sent }{sent by
34446 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34447 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34449 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34451 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34454 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34456 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34459 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34460 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34461 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34462 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34463 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34467 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34468 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34470 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34471 the delayed addresses.
34473 The third item then ends the message.
34476 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34477 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34479 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34480 $warn_message_delay
34482 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34484 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34485 {that you sent }{sent by
34489 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34490 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34492 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34493 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34494 The date of the message is: $h_date
34496 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34498 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34499 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34500 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34501 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34502 the message will be returned to you.
34504 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34505 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34506 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34507 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34508 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34509 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34510 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34511 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34517 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34518 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34520 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34521 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34522 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34526 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34527 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34528 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34529 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34530 routing explicitly:
34532 send_to_smart_host:
34533 driver = manualroute
34534 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34535 transport = remote_smtp
34537 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34538 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34539 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34540 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34541 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34546 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34547 .cindex "mailing lists"
34548 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34549 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34550 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34552 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34553 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34554 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34555 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34559 domains = lists.example
34560 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34563 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34566 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34567 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34568 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34569 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34571 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34572 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34575 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34576 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34577 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34578 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34579 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34581 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34582 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34583 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34584 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34585 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34586 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34587 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34588 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34589 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34593 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34594 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34595 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34596 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34597 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34598 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34599 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34601 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34602 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34603 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34604 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34605 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34609 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34610 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34611 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34612 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34613 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34614 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34615 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34616 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34617 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34618 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34620 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34621 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34622 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34623 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34624 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34625 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34626 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34627 pre-existing messages.
34629 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34630 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34631 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34632 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34633 one level of expansion anyway.
34637 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34638 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34639 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34640 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34641 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34642 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34644 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34645 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34649 domains = lists.example
34650 local_part_suffix = -request
34651 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34656 domains = lists.example
34657 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34658 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34659 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34662 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34667 domains = lists.example
34669 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34671 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34672 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34673 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34676 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34677 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34678 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34679 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34680 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34681 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34682 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34683 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34684 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34686 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34687 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34688 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34693 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34695 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34696 .cindex "envelope sender"
34697 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34698 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34699 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34700 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34701 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34702 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34704 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34705 .oindex &%return_path%&
34706 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34707 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34708 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34709 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34710 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34711 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34712 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34718 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34719 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34721 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34722 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34723 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34724 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34725 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34726 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34727 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34730 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34732 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34733 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34734 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34735 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34736 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34737 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34739 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34740 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34741 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34742 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34746 domains = ! +local_domains
34748 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34749 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34752 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34753 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34754 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34755 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34758 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34759 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34760 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34761 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34762 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34766 domains = ! +local_domains
34767 transport = remote_smtp
34769 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34770 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34773 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34774 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34775 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34776 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34779 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34780 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34781 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34782 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34783 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34784 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34792 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34793 .cindex "virtual domains"
34794 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34795 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34799 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34800 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34801 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34803 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34804 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34805 have login accounts on that host.
34808 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34809 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34810 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34811 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34812 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34813 to a router of this form:
34817 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34818 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34821 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34822 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34823 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34824 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34825 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34826 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34828 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34829 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34830 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34831 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34833 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34834 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34835 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34839 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34840 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34841 transport = my_mailboxes
34843 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34844 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34845 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34846 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34847 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34851 driver = appendfile
34852 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34855 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34856 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34858 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34859 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34860 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34861 information about the domains.
34865 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34866 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34867 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34868 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34869 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34870 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34871 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34872 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34873 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34874 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34875 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34876 example, consider this router:
34881 file = $home/.forward
34882 local_part_suffix = -*
34883 local_part_suffix_optional
34886 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34887 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34888 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34889 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34891 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34892 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34895 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34896 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34897 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34898 control over which suffixes are valid.
34900 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34901 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34907 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34908 local_part_suffix = -*
34909 local_part_suffix_optional
34912 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34913 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34914 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34915 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34916 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34920 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34921 .cindex "vacation processing"
34922 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34923 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34924 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34925 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34926 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34929 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34930 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34931 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34932 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34934 spqr, vacation-spqr
34937 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34938 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34939 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34940 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34941 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34945 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34946 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34950 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34951 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34952 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34953 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34954 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34955 each day's messages.
34957 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34958 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34959 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34960 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34964 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34965 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34966 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34967 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34968 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34969 permanently connected.
34971 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34972 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34973 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34976 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34977 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34978 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34979 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34980 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34981 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34982 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34983 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34985 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34986 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34987 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34988 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34989 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34990 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34993 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34994 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34995 intermittent host. For example:
34997 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34999 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35000 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35001 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35002 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35003 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35004 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35007 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35008 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35009 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35010 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35011 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35012 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35013 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35017 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35018 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35019 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35020 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35021 delivered immediately.
35023 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35024 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35025 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35026 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35027 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35028 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35029 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35030 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35031 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35032 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35033 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35034 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35035 single SMTP connection.
35039 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35040 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35042 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35043 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35044 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35045 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35046 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35047 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35048 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35049 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35050 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35051 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35054 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35055 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35056 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35057 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35058 email is not desirable.
35060 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35061 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35062 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35063 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35064 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35065 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35066 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35068 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35069 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35070 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35071 before sending a message to the smart host.
35073 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35074 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35075 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35077 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35078 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35079 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35080 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35081 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35082 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35083 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35085 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35089 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35090 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35092 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35093 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35094 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35095 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35096 successful, a zero return code is given.
35098 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35099 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35100 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35101 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35102 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35105 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35106 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35107 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35109 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35110 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35111 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35112 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35113 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35115 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35116 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35117 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35119 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35120 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35121 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35122 are ever generated.
35124 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35126 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35127 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35128 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35131 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35132 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35133 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35134 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35135 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35136 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35141 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35144 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35145 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35146 .cindex "log" "types of"
35147 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35152 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35153 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35154 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35155 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35156 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35157 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35158 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35159 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35161 .cindex "reject log"
35162 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35163 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35164 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35165 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35166 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35167 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35168 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35169 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35170 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35173 .cindex "panic log"
35174 .cindex "system log"
35175 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35176 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35177 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35178 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35179 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35180 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35181 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35182 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35183 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35186 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35187 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35188 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35190 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35193 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35194 ways of changing this:
35197 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35202 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35204 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35207 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35211 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35212 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35213 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35214 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35215 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35216 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35221 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35222 .cindex "log" "destination"
35223 .cindex "log" "to file"
35224 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35226 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35227 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35228 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35229 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35230 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35231 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35232 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35234 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35235 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35236 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35237 references to the host name:
35239 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35241 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35242 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35243 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35244 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35245 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35248 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35249 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35250 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35251 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35252 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35253 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35254 implying the use of a default path.
35256 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35257 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35258 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35259 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35260 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35261 equivalent to the setting:
35263 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35265 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35266 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35267 that is where the logs are written.
35269 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35270 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35272 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35274 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35275 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35276 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35277 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35279 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35284 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35285 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35286 .cindex "cycling logs"
35287 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35288 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35289 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35290 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35291 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35292 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35293 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35295 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35296 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35297 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35298 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35299 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35300 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35301 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35302 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35303 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35304 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35305 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35310 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35311 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35312 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35313 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35314 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35315 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35316 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35317 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35319 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35320 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35321 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35322 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35324 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35325 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35327 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35328 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35329 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35330 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35332 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35333 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35334 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35335 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35337 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35338 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35339 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35340 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35341 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35342 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35345 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35346 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35347 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35348 /var/log/exim/panic
35352 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35353 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35354 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35355 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35356 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35357 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35358 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35359 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35360 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35361 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35362 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35363 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35364 the time and host name to each line.
35365 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35368 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35370 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35372 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35375 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35376 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35377 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35378 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35380 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35381 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35382 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35383 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35384 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35385 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35386 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35387 RFC 3164, you should set
35389 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35391 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35392 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35394 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35395 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35396 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35397 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35398 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35399 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35400 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35401 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35402 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35404 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35405 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35406 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35407 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35410 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35413 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35414 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35415 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35416 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35418 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35419 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35420 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35421 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35422 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35423 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35425 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35426 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35427 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35430 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35432 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35433 without modification.
35435 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35436 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35437 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35442 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35443 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35444 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35445 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35446 timestamp. The flags are:
35448 &`<=`& message arrival
35449 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35450 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35451 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35452 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35453 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35454 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35458 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35459 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35460 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35461 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35462 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35464 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35465 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35466 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35468 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35469 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35470 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35474 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35478 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35479 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35480 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35481 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35482 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35483 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35484 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35485 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35486 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35487 name in parentheses.
35489 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35490 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35491 the log containing text like these examples:
35493 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35494 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35496 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35499 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35500 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35503 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35504 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35505 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35506 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35507 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35508 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35509 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35510 suite that was used.
35512 .cindex log protocol
35513 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35514 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35515 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35516 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35517 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35518 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35519 authenticator name.
35521 .cindex "size" "of message"
35522 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35523 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35524 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35525 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35528 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35529 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35533 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35534 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35535 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35536 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35537 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35538 to fit it on the page:
35540 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35541 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35542 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35543 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35544 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35546 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35547 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35548 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35549 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35550 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35552 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35553 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35554 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35555 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35557 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35558 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35560 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35562 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35563 parentheses afterwards.
35565 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35566 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35567 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35568 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35569 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35570 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35572 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35573 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35574 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35575 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35576 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35578 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35579 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35581 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35582 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35585 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35586 .cindex "discarded messages"
35587 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35588 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35589 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35590 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35592 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35593 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35595 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35596 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35598 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35599 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35603 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35604 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35606 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35607 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35609 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35610 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35611 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35613 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35614 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35616 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35617 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35618 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35622 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35623 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35624 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35625 following form is logged:
35627 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35628 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35630 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35631 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35633 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35634 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35635 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35636 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35637 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35639 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35640 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35641 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35642 flagged with &`**`&.
35646 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35647 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35648 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35649 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35650 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35654 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35657 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35659 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35660 at the end of its processing.
35665 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35666 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35667 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35668 the following table:
35670 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35671 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35672 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35673 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35674 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35675 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35676 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35677 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35678 &`H `& host name and IP address
35679 &`I `& local interface used
35680 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35681 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35682 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35683 &`PRX `& on &'<='& and&`=>`& lines: proxy address
35684 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35685 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35686 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35687 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35688 &`S `& size of message in bytes
35689 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35690 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35691 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35692 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35693 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35694 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35698 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35699 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35700 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35703 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35704 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35705 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35706 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35707 during the first delivery attempt.
35709 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35710 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35711 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35713 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35714 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35715 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35716 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35717 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35720 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35721 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35724 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35725 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35727 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35728 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35730 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35731 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35732 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35736 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35744 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35745 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35746 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35747 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35748 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35751 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35753 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35754 selection marked by asterisks:
35756 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35757 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35758 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35759 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35760 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35761 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35762 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35763 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35764 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35765 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35766 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35767 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35768 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35769 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35770 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35771 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35773 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35775 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35776 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35777 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35778 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35779 &` pid `& Exim process id
35781 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
35783 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35784 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35785 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35786 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35787 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35788 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35789 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35790 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35791 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35792 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35793 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35794 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35795 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35796 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35797 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35798 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35799 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35800 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35801 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35802 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35803 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35804 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35806 &` all `& all of the above
35808 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35809 section &<<SECID99>>&
35811 More details on each of these items follows:
35815 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35816 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35817 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35818 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35819 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35820 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35822 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35823 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35824 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35825 this log selector is set.
35827 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35828 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35829 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35830 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35831 such users cannot access the log).
35833 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35834 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35835 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35836 parentheses between them.
35838 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35839 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35840 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35841 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35842 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35843 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35844 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35845 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35846 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35847 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35848 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35849 between the caller and Exim.
35851 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35852 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35853 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35855 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35856 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35857 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35858 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35859 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35860 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35862 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35863 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35864 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35866 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35867 .cindex "size" "of message"
35868 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35869 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35871 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35872 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35873 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35874 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35875 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35877 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35878 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35879 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35880 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35881 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35882 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35884 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35885 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35886 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35887 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35888 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35890 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35891 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35892 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35893 client's ident port times out.
35895 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35896 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35897 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35898 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35899 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35900 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35901 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35902 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35903 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35904 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35906 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35910 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
35911 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
35912 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
35913 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
35914 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
35915 on a proxied connection
35916 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection..
35917 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
35920 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35921 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35922 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35923 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35924 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35925 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35926 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35927 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35928 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35929 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35930 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35932 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35933 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35934 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35936 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35937 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35938 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35939 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35940 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35942 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35943 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35944 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35945 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35948 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35949 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35950 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35951 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35952 containing => tags) following the IP address.
35954 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35955 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35957 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35958 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35959 local port is a random ephemeral port.
35961 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35962 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35963 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35964 immediately after the time and date.
35966 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35967 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35968 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35970 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35971 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35972 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35973 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35974 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35975 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35976 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35977 message has been successfully received.
35979 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35980 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35981 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35982 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35984 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35985 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35986 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35987 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35988 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35990 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35993 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35994 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35995 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35996 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35998 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35999 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36000 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36001 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36002 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36004 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36005 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36006 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36007 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36010 .cindex "log" "return path"
36011 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36012 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36013 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36014 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36016 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36017 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36018 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36019 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36020 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36022 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36023 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36024 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36025 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36028 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36029 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36032 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36033 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36034 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36035 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36037 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36038 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36040 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36041 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36042 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36043 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36044 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36045 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36048 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36049 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36050 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36051 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36052 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36053 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36054 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36055 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36056 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36057 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36059 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36060 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36061 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36062 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36063 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36064 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36065 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36066 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36068 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36069 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36070 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36071 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36072 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36073 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36075 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36076 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36077 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36078 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36079 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36080 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36081 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36082 already have their own log lines.
36084 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36085 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36086 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36087 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36088 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36089 the same logging options.
36091 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36092 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36096 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36097 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36098 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36099 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36100 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36102 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36103 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36104 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36105 was accepted or used.
36107 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36108 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36109 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36110 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36111 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36112 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36113 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36114 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36116 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36117 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36118 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36119 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36120 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36121 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36122 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36123 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36124 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36126 .cindex "log" "subject"
36127 .cindex "subject, logging"
36128 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36129 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36130 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36131 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36132 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36134 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36135 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36136 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36137 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
36139 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36140 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36141 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36142 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36144 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36145 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36146 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36147 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36148 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36150 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36151 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36152 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36153 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36154 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36156 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36157 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36158 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36162 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36163 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36164 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36165 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36166 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36167 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36168 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36169 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36170 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36171 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36172 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36173 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36174 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36176 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36177 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36178 &%message_logs%& option false.
36184 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36187 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36188 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36189 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36190 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36191 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36193 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36194 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36195 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36196 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36197 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36198 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36199 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36201 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36202 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36203 "extract statistics from the log"
36204 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36205 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36206 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36207 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36208 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36209 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36210 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36211 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36214 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36215 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36216 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36221 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36222 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36223 .cindex "process, querying"
36225 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36226 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36227 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36228 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36229 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36230 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36231 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36232 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36234 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36235 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36236 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36239 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36240 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36241 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36242 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36243 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36246 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36247 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36248 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36249 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36251 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36253 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36254 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36255 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36256 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36257 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36258 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36260 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36261 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36265 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36266 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36267 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36268 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36272 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36276 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36277 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36279 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36280 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36283 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36284 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36285 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36289 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36290 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36291 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36293 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36294 Match against the size field.
36296 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36297 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36299 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36300 Match messages that are older than the given time.
36303 Match only frozen messages.
36306 Match only non-frozen messages.
36309 The following options control the format of the output:
36313 Display only the count of matching messages.
36316 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36320 Display message ids only.
36323 Brief format &-- one line per message.
36326 Display messages in reverse order.
36329 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36332 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36336 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36337 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36338 .cindex "queue" "summary"
36339 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36340 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36341 running a command such as
36343 exim -bp | exiqsumm
36345 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36346 it, as in the following example:
36348 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36350 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36351 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36352 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36353 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36355 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36356 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36357 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36358 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36359 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36360 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36363 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36364 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36365 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36366 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36367 level"& addresses).
36372 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36374 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36375 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36376 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36377 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36378 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36379 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36380 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36381 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36382 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36383 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36385 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36387 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36389 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36390 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36391 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36393 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36394 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36395 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36396 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36397 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36399 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36400 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36401 regular expression.
36403 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36404 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36406 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36407 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36411 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36412 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36413 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36414 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36415 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36416 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36419 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36420 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36421 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36422 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36423 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36426 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36427 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36428 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36429 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36430 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36431 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36432 the &%--help%& option.
36435 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36436 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36437 .cindex "cycling logs"
36438 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36439 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36440 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36441 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36442 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36443 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36444 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36446 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36447 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36449 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36450 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36451 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36455 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36456 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36457 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36458 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36459 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36460 logs are handled similarly.
36462 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36463 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36464 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36465 any existing log files.
36467 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36468 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36469 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36470 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36471 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36473 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36475 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36476 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36480 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36481 .cindex "statistics"
36482 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36483 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36484 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36485 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36486 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36488 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36489 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36490 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36491 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36492 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36494 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36496 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36497 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36498 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36499 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36500 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36501 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36502 also produced per user.
36504 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36505 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36506 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36507 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36508 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36510 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36511 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36512 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36513 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36514 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36515 an entirely separate message.
36517 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36518 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36519 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36520 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36521 least one address that failed.
36523 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36524 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36525 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36526 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36527 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36528 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36529 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36531 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36532 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36533 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36535 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36536 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36537 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36539 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36542 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36543 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36544 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36545 .cindex "checking access"
36546 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36547 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36548 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36549 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36550 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36551 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36553 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36554 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36556 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36558 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36559 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36560 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36561 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36564 550 Relay not permitted
36566 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36567 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36568 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36569 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36572 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36573 -f himself@there.example
36575 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36576 mandatory arguments.
36578 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36579 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36580 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36584 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36585 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36586 .cindex "building DBM files"
36587 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36588 .cindex "lower casing"
36589 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36590 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36591 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36592 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36593 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36594 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36596 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36597 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36598 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36599 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36602 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36603 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36604 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36608 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36609 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36610 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36611 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36613 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36615 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36616 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36618 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36619 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36620 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36621 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36622 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36623 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36625 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36626 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36627 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36628 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36629 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36630 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36631 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36637 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36638 .cindex "retry" "times"
36639 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36640 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36641 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36642 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36643 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36644 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36645 output. For example:
36647 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36648 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36649 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36650 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36651 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36652 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36653 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36654 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36655 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36656 past final cutoff time
36658 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36659 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36660 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36661 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36662 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36663 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36666 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36667 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36668 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36669 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36670 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36671 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36675 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36676 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36677 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36678 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36679 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36680 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36681 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36684 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36686 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36689 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36691 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36693 &'misc'&: other hints data
36696 The &'misc'& database is used for
36699 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36701 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36702 &(smtp)& transport)
36704 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36710 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36711 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36712 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36713 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36714 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36716 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36718 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36720 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36721 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36723 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36724 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36725 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36726 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36727 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36728 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36729 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36730 and a textual description of the error.
36732 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36733 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36734 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36737 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36738 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36739 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36740 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36741 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36742 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36747 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36748 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36749 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36750 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36751 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36752 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36753 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36754 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36755 updated sufficiently often.
36757 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36758 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36759 the retry database:
36761 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36763 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36764 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36765 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36766 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36767 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36768 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36769 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36770 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36771 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36772 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36773 whenever it removes information from the database.
36775 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36776 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36777 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36778 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36779 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36781 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36782 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36783 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36784 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36785 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36786 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36787 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36790 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36791 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36796 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36797 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36798 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36799 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36800 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36801 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36802 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36805 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36806 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36807 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36808 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36809 by new data, for example:
36813 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36814 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36815 used as optional separators.
36820 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36821 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36822 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36823 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36824 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36825 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36826 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36827 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36828 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36829 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36830 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36831 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36832 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36836 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36839 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36842 .vitem &%-interval%&
36843 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36844 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36846 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36847 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36850 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36853 Suppress verification output.
36855 .vitem &%-retries%&
36856 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36857 the lock (default 10).
36859 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36860 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36861 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36862 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36865 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36866 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36867 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36868 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36871 Generate verbose output.
36874 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36875 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36876 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36877 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36878 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36879 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36880 more than 30 minutes old.
36882 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36883 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36884 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36885 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36886 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36887 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36889 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36890 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36891 suppresses all output except error messages.
36895 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36897 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36899 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36900 <&'some commands'&>
36903 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36904 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36907 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36908 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36910 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36911 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36915 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36916 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36918 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36919 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36920 .cindex "X-windows"
36921 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36922 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36923 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36924 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36925 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36926 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36927 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36928 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36932 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36933 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36934 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36935 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36936 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36937 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36938 parameters are for.
36940 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36941 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36942 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36944 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36946 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36947 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36948 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36949 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36950 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36952 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36953 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36955 Eximon*background: gray94
36957 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36958 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36959 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36960 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36961 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36962 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36963 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36966 Eximon*highlight: gray
36969 .cindex "admin user"
36970 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36971 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36973 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36974 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36975 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36976 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36977 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36979 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36980 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36981 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36982 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36983 different parts of the display.
36988 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36989 .cindex "stripchart"
36990 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36991 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36992 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36993 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36994 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36995 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36996 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36997 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36998 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37000 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37001 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37002 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37003 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37005 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37006 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37007 to a single partition.
37009 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37010 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37011 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37012 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37013 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37014 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37015 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37020 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37021 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37022 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37023 .cindex "window size"
37024 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37025 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37026 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37027 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37028 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37029 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37031 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37032 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37033 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37034 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37036 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37037 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37038 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37039 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37040 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37041 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37043 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37044 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37045 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37049 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37050 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37051 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37052 the main log is maintained.
37053 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37054 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37055 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37056 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37057 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37059 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37060 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37061 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37062 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37063 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37064 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37065 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37066 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37067 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37068 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37069 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37071 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37072 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37073 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37074 It cannot go further back up the log.
37076 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37077 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37078 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37079 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37080 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37081 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37083 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37084 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37085 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37086 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37087 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37088 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37090 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37091 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37092 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37093 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37094 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37095 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37096 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37097 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37098 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37103 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37104 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37105 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37106 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37107 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37108 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37109 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37110 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37111 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37112 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37114 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37115 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37116 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37117 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37118 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37119 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37120 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37122 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37123 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37124 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37125 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37126 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37127 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37128 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37130 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37131 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37132 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37133 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37135 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37136 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37137 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37138 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37139 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37140 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37141 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37144 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37145 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37147 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37148 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37149 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37150 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37151 display is updated.
37155 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37156 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37157 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37158 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37159 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37162 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37163 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37164 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37165 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37166 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37168 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37170 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37174 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37175 in a new text window.
37177 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37178 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37179 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37181 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37182 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37183 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37184 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37186 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37187 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37188 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37189 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37190 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37192 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37193 that the message be frozen.
37195 .cindex "thawing messages"
37196 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37197 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37198 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37199 that the message be thawed.
37201 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37202 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37203 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37204 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37206 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37207 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37210 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37211 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37212 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37213 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37214 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37215 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37216 which case no action is taken.
37218 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37219 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37220 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37221 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37222 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37223 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37224 case no action is taken.
37226 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37227 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37229 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37230 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37231 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37232 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37233 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37234 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37235 the address is qualified with that domain.
37238 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37239 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37240 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37241 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37242 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37243 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37244 if no output is generated.
37246 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37247 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37249 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37251 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37252 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37253 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37260 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37261 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37263 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37264 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37265 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37266 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37268 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37269 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37270 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37271 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37272 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37273 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37275 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37276 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37277 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37278 as soon as possible.
37281 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37282 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37283 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37284 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37285 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37286 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37289 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37290 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37291 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37292 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37293 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37294 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37296 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37297 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37298 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37299 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37302 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37303 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37304 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37305 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37306 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37307 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37308 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37309 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37310 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37314 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37315 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37316 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37317 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37318 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37319 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37320 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37322 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37325 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37326 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37327 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37328 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37329 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37334 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37336 .cindex "root privilege"
37337 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37338 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37339 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37340 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37341 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37342 is required for two things:
37345 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37346 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37349 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37350 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37354 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37355 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37356 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37357 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37358 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37359 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37360 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37361 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37363 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37364 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37365 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37367 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37368 uid and gid in the following cases:
37373 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37374 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37375 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37376 the calling process.
37377 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37378 option may not be used at all.
37379 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37380 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37381 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37386 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37387 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37390 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37391 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37392 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37393 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37394 testing address verification
37397 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37400 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37401 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37404 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37407 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37408 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37409 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37410 will be used during message reception.
37412 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37413 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37415 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37416 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37417 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37418 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37419 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37420 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37421 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37422 generating bounce and warning messages.
37424 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37425 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37426 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37427 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37429 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37430 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37436 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37437 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37438 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37439 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37440 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37441 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37442 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37443 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37444 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37445 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37449 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37450 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37451 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37452 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37454 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37455 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37456 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37457 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37458 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37460 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37461 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37462 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37465 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37466 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37467 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37469 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37470 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37471 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37472 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37473 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37474 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37475 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37476 address this problem at this time.
37478 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37479 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37480 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37481 be used in the most straightforward way.
37483 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37484 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37487 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37488 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37489 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37490 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37491 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37493 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37494 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37496 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37497 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37498 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37499 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37501 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37502 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37505 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37506 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37507 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37509 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37510 owned by the Exim user.
37512 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37513 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37514 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37519 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37520 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37521 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37522 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37524 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37525 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37530 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37531 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37532 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37536 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37537 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37538 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37539 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37540 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37541 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37542 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37545 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37546 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37547 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37548 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37549 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37551 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37552 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37553 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37554 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37555 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37556 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37557 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37559 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37560 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37561 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37563 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37564 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37566 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37567 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37568 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37570 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37571 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37572 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37574 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37575 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37576 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37577 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37583 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37584 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37585 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37586 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37587 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37588 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37589 are some issues to be aware of:
37592 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37594 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37596 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37597 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37598 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37599 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37600 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37601 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37604 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37605 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37606 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37608 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37609 expected to yield one result.
37615 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37616 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37617 .cindex "IP source routing"
37618 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37619 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37620 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37621 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37625 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37626 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37627 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37632 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37633 .cindex "trusted users"
37634 .cindex "admin user"
37635 .cindex "privileged user"
37636 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37637 .cindex "user" "admin"
37638 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37639 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37640 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37641 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37642 permit a remote host to be specified.
37645 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37646 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37647 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37648 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37649 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37650 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37652 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37653 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37654 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37655 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37656 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37658 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37659 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37660 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37661 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37662 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37666 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37667 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37668 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37669 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37670 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37671 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37673 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37674 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37675 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37676 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37677 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37678 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37683 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37684 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37685 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37686 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37687 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37688 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37692 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37693 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37694 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37695 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37696 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37701 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37702 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37703 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37704 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37709 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37710 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37711 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37712 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37713 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37717 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37718 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37719 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37723 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37724 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37725 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37726 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37727 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37728 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37729 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37731 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37732 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37737 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37738 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37739 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37740 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37744 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37745 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37746 enough to hold the result.
37747 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37752 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37753 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37755 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37756 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37757 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37758 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37759 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37760 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37761 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37762 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37763 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37764 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37765 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37766 themselves are recoverable.
37768 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37769 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37770 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37773 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37774 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37775 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37776 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37777 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37779 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37780 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37781 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37782 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37783 will always be the case.
37785 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37787 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37790 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37792 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37793 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37794 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37795 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37796 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37797 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37798 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37799 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37802 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37803 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37804 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37805 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37806 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37807 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37808 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37809 normally the Exim user.
37811 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37812 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37813 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37814 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37815 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37816 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37817 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37818 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37820 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37821 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37822 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37823 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37825 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37826 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37829 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37830 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37831 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37832 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37833 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37834 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37835 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37836 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37837 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37840 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37841 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37842 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37843 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37844 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37845 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37847 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37848 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37849 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37850 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37851 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37852 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37854 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37855 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37856 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37858 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37859 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37860 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37861 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37862 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37864 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37865 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37866 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37867 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37868 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37870 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37871 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37872 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37874 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37875 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37876 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37878 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37879 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37882 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37883 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37884 present if the number is greater than zero.
37886 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37887 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37888 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37890 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37891 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37892 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37894 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37895 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37898 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37899 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37900 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37903 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37904 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37905 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37906 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37908 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37909 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37910 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37912 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37913 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37914 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37915 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37916 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37917 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37919 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37920 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37921 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37922 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37923 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37925 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37926 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37927 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37928 generated messages.
37931 The message is from a local sender.
37933 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37934 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37936 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37937 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37938 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37939 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37941 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37942 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37943 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37946 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37947 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37950 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37951 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37952 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37954 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37955 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37956 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37958 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37959 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37960 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37962 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37963 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37964 certificate was verified by the server.
37966 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37967 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37968 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37970 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37971 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37972 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37976 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37977 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37978 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37979 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37980 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37981 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37982 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37983 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37984 addresses are complete.
37986 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37987 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37988 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37989 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37990 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37991 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37993 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37994 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37995 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37997 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37998 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37999 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38000 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38004 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38005 darcy@austen.fict.example
38007 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38009 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38010 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38011 line is of the following form:
38013 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38014 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38016 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38017 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38018 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38019 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38020 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38021 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38022 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38023 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38026 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38027 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38028 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38029 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38030 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38034 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38035 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38036 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38037 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38038 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38039 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38040 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38041 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38042 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38043 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38046 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38047 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38048 typical set of headers:
38050 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38051 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38052 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38053 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38054 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38055 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38056 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38057 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38058 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38059 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38060 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38062 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38063 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38064 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38065 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38066 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38067 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38070 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38072 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38076 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38077 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38078 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38079 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
38082 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38084 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38086 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
38088 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38089 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38090 (including transport filters)
38091 except cutthrough delivery.
38093 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38094 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38095 different signature contexts.
38098 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38099 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38100 Exim's standard controls.
38102 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38103 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
38104 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38105 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38107 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38108 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38109 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38110 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38112 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38113 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38114 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38115 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38119 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38120 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38122 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38123 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38125 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
38127 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
38128 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
38130 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
38132 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
38133 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
38134 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38135 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38137 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38139 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38140 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38141 The result can either
38143 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
38145 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38148 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38149 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38153 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38155 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38156 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38157 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38158 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38160 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38162 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38163 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38164 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38165 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38168 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
38170 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
38171 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
38172 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
38176 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
38177 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38179 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
38180 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38181 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38182 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38183 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38184 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
38185 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38187 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38188 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38189 runtime of the ACL.
38191 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38192 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38193 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38194 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38196 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38197 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38198 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38199 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38200 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38201 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
38204 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
38206 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
38207 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
38208 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
38210 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
38212 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
38213 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
38214 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
38216 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
38219 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
38220 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
38223 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
38224 available (from most to least important):
38228 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
38229 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
38230 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
38231 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
38232 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
38233 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
38235 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
38236 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38238 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
38239 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38241 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
38242 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38244 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
38246 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
38247 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
38248 "fail" or "invalid". One of
38250 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
38251 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
38253 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
38254 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
38256 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
38257 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
38258 means that the message body was modified in transit.
38260 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
38261 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
38262 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
38263 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
38265 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
38266 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
38267 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
38268 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38269 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
38270 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
38271 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
38272 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38273 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
38274 The key record selector string.
38275 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
38276 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
38277 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
38278 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38279 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
38280 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38281 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
38282 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
38283 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
38284 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
38285 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
38286 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
38287 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
38288 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
38289 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
38290 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
38291 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
38292 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
38293 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
38294 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
38295 integer size comparisons against this value.
38296 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
38297 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
38298 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
38299 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38300 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38301 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38302 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38303 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38305 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38306 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38308 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38309 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38310 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38311 Number of bits in the key.
38314 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38317 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38318 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38319 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38320 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38321 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38324 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
38325 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
38326 sender_domains = gmail.com
38327 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38331 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
38332 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38333 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38334 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38337 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38338 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38339 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38340 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38343 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38344 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38345 for more information of what they mean.
38348 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38349 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38351 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
38353 .cindex "proxy support"
38354 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
38357 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
38358 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
38361 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
38362 .cindex proxy inbound
38363 .cindex proxy "server side"
38364 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
38365 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
38367 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
38368 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
38369 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
38372 It was built on specifications from:
38373 http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt
38374 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
38375 http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e
38377 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
38378 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
38379 to distribute load.
38380 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
38381 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
38382 There is no logging if a host passes or
38383 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
38384 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
38386 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
38387 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
38388 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
38390 The following expansion variables are usable
38391 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
38394 &'proxy_host_address '& internal IP address of the proxy
38395 &'proxy_host_port '& internal TCP port of the proxy
38396 &'proxy_target_address '& external IP address of the proxy
38397 &'proxy_target_port '& external TCP port of the proxy
38398 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
38400 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_host_address$& is empty
38401 there was a protocol error.
38403 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
38404 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
38405 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
38406 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
38407 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
38408 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
38409 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
38410 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
38411 A possible solution is:
38413 # Set max number of connections per host
38415 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
38416 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
38418 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
38419 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
38424 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
38425 .cindex proxy outbound
38426 .cindex proxy "client side"
38427 .cindex proxy SOCKS
38428 .cindex SOCKS proxy
38429 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
38430 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
38431 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
38434 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
38435 on an smtp transport.
38436 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
38437 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
38438 Each proxy specifier is a list
38439 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
38440 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
38442 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
38443 The list of options is in the following table:
38445 &'auth '& authentication method
38446 &'name '& authentication username
38447 &'pass '& authentication password
38449 &'tmo '& connection timeout
38451 &'weight '& selection bias
38454 More details on each of these options follows:
38457 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
38458 .cindex proxy authentication
38459 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
38460 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
38461 for access to the proxy.
38462 Default is &"none"&.
38464 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
38467 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
38470 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
38473 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
38476 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
38477 higher values being tried first.
38478 The default priority is 1.
38480 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
38481 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
38482 weighted by this value.
38483 The default value for selection bias is 1.
38486 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
38487 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
38488 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
38490 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
38491 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
38492 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
38493 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
38496 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38497 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38499 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
38500 "Internationalisation""
38501 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
38504 .cindex UTF-8 "mail name handling"
38507 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
38508 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
38509 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
38511 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
38512 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
38513 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
38514 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
38515 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
38516 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
38518 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
38519 international handling for the message is enabled and
38520 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
38522 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
38523 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
38524 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
38525 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
38527 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
38528 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
38529 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
38530 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
38532 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
38533 components expanded to a-label form,
38534 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
38537 .cindex log protocol
38538 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
38539 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
38540 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
38542 The following expansion operator can be used:
38544 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
38545 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
38546 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
38547 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
38550 ACLs may use the following modifier:
38552 control = utf8_downconvert
38553 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
38555 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
38556 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
38557 Message Submission Agent context.
38558 If a value is appended it may be:
38560 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
38561 &`0 `& no downconversion
38562 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
38565 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
38566 is initially set to -1.
38569 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
38570 Configurations supporting these should inspect
38571 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
38573 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
38574 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
38575 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
38577 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
38578 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
38582 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
38583 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
38584 the following expansion operator can be used:
38586 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
38589 The string is converted from the charset specified by
38590 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
38591 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
38593 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
38594 with the following exception: All occurences of <sep>
38595 (which has to be a single character)
38596 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
38597 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
38599 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
38600 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
38602 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
38603 by many other IMAP servers.
38607 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
38608 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
38609 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
38612 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
38613 must be representable in UTF-16.
38617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38620 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
38625 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
38626 of points. It was originally invented to giave a way to do customised logging
38627 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
38628 processing actions.
38630 Most installations will never need to use Events.
38631 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
38632 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38634 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
38635 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
38636 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
38638 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
38639 An example might look like:
38640 .cindex logging custom
38642 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
38643 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
38644 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
38645 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
38646 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
38647 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
38648 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
38649 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
38650 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
38654 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
38655 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
38656 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
38658 The current list of events is:
38660 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
38661 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
38662 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
38663 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
38664 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
38665 &`msg:fail:delivery after main `& per recipient
38666 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
38667 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
38668 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
38669 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
38670 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
38672 New event types may be added in future.
38674 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
38675 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
38676 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
38678 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
38679 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
38680 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
38682 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
38683 with the event type:
38685 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation mssage
38686 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
38687 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
38688 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
38689 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
38690 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
38693 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
38695 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
38696 however due to the multiple contextx that Exim operates in during
38697 the course of its processing:
38699 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
38702 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
38703 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
38705 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
38706 a useful way of writing to the main log.
38708 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
38709 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
38710 following will be forced:
38712 &`msg:delivery `& (ignored)
38713 &`msg:host:defer `& (ignored)
38714 &`msg:fail:delivery`& (ignored)
38715 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
38716 &`tcp:close `& (ignored)
38717 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
38718 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
38720 No other use is made of the result string.
38722 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
38723 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
38726 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
38727 chain element received on the connection.
38728 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
38732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38735 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
38736 "Adding drivers or lookups"
38737 .cindex "adding drivers"
38738 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
38739 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
38740 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
38741 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
38744 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
38745 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38747 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38749 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38751 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38752 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38753 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38755 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38757 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38760 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38761 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38763 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38764 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38765 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38766 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38767 simple form that most lookups have.
38769 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38770 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38771 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38773 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38776 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38777 as for other drivers and lookups.
38780 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38781 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38782 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38783 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38784 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38786 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38787 the interface that is expected.
38792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38795 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38796 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38797 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38798 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38800 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38805 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38806 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38810 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38811 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38812 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38815 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38816 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////